xref: /linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision 2c956a5ad4de7376ee792e888809edf2b2b39b86)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
14 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
15 #include <linux/list.h>
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/netlink.h>
18 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
19 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
20 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
21 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
22 #include <linux/net.h>
23 #include <net/regulatory.h>
24 
25 /**
26  * DOC: Introduction
27  *
28  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
29  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
30  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
31  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
32  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
33  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
34  *
35  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
36  * use restrictions.
37  */
38 
39 
40 /**
41  * DOC: Device registration
42  *
43  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
44  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
45  * described below.
46  *
47  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
48  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
49  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
50  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
51  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
52  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
53  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
54  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
55  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
56  *
57  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
58  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
59  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
60  */
61 
62 struct wiphy;
63 
64 /*
65  * wireless hardware capability structures
66  */
67 
68 /**
69  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
70  *
71  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
72  *
73  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
74  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
75  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
78  *	is not permitted.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
80  *	is not permitted.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
83  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
84  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
85  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
86  *	restrictions.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
93  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
94  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
95  *	on this channel.
96  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
97  *	on this channel.
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
104  *	on this channel.
105  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106  *	on this channel.
107  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108  *	on this channel.
109  *
110  */
111 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
112 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
113 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
114 	/* hole at 1<<2 */
115 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
116 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
117 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
118 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
119 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
120 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
121 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
131 };
132 
133 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
134 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
135 
136 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
137 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
138 
139 /**
140  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
141  *
142  * This structure describes a single channel for use
143  * with cfg80211.
144  *
145  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
146  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
147  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
148  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
149  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
150  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
151  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
152  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
153  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
154  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
155  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
156  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
157  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
158  * @orig_mag: internal use
159  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
160  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
161  *	on this channel.
162  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
163  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
164  */
165 struct ieee80211_channel {
166 	enum nl80211_band band;
167 	u32 center_freq;
168 	u16 freq_offset;
169 	u16 hw_value;
170 	u32 flags;
171 	int max_antenna_gain;
172 	int max_power;
173 	int max_reg_power;
174 	bool beacon_found;
175 	u32 orig_flags;
176 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
177 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
178 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
179 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
180 };
181 
182 /**
183  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
184  *
185  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
186  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
187  * different bands/PHY modes.
188  *
189  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
190  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
191  *	with CCK rates.
192  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
193  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
194  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
195  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
196  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
197  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
198  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
199  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
200  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
201  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
202  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
203  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
204  */
205 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
206 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
207 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
208 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
209 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
210 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
211 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
212 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
213 };
214 
215 /**
216  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
217  *
218  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
219  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
220  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
221  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
222  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
223  */
224 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
225 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
226 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
227 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
228 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
229 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
234  *
235  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
236  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
237  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
238  */
239 enum ieee80211_privacy {
240 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
241 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
242 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
243 };
244 
245 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
246 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
247 
248 /**
249  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
250  *
251  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
252  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
253  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
254  * passed around.
255  *
256  * @flags: rate-specific flags
257  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
258  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
259  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
260  *	short preamble is used
261  */
262 struct ieee80211_rate {
263 	u32 flags;
264 	u16 bitrate;
265 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
266 };
267 
268 /**
269  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
270  *
271  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
272  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
273  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
274  */
275 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
276 	bool enable;
277 	u8 min_offset;
278 	u8 max_offset;
279 };
280 
281 /**
282  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
283  *
284  * @color: the current color.
285  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
286  * @partial: define the AID equation.
287  */
288 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
289 	u8 color;
290 	bool enabled;
291 	bool partial;
292 };
293 
294 /**
295  * struct ieee80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
296  *
297  * @color: the current color.
298  * @disabled: is the feature disabled.
299  * @partial: define the AID equation.
300  */
301 struct ieee80211_he_bss_color {
302 	u8 color;
303 	bool disabled;
304 	bool partial;
305 };
306 
307 /**
308  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
309  *
310  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
311  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
312  *
313  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
314  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
315  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
316  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
317  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
318  */
319 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
320 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
321 	bool ht_supported;
322 	u8 ampdu_factor;
323 	u8 ampdu_density;
324 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
325 };
326 
327 /**
328  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
329  *
330  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
331  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
332  *
333  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
334  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
335  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
336  */
337 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
338 	bool vht_supported;
339 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
340 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
341 };
342 
343 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
344 
345 /**
346  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
347  *
348  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
349  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
350  *
351  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
352  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
353  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
354  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
355  */
356 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
357 	bool has_he;
358 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
359 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
360 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
361 };
362 
363 /**
364  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data
365  *
366  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
367  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
368  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
369  *
370  * @types_mask: interface types mask
371  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
372  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
373  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
374  */
375 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
376 	u16 types_mask;
377 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
378 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
379 };
380 
381 /**
382  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
383  *
384  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
385  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
386  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
387  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
388  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
389  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
390  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
391  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
392  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
393  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
394  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
395  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
396  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
397  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
398  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
399  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
400  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
401  */
402 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
403 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
404 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
405 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
406 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
407 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
408 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
409 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
410 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
411 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
412 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
413 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
414 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
415 };
416 
417 /**
418  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
419  *
420  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
421  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
422  *
423  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
424  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
425  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
426  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
427  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
428  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
429  */
430 struct ieee80211_edmg {
431 	u8 channels;
432 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
433 };
434 
435 /**
436  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
437  *
438  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
439  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
440  *
441  * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA
442  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
443  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
444  */
445 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
446 	bool s1g;
447 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
448 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
449 };
450 
451 /**
452  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
453  *
454  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
455  * is able to operate in.
456  *
457  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
458  *	in this band.
459  * @band: the band this structure represents
460  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
461  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
462  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
463  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
464  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
465  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
466  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
467  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
468  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
469  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
470  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
471  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
472  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
473  *	iftype_data).
474  */
475 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
476 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
477 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
478 	enum nl80211_band band;
479 	int n_channels;
480 	int n_bitrates;
481 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
482 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
483 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
484 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
485 	u16 n_iftype_data;
486 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
487 };
488 
489 /**
490  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
491  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
492  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
493  *
494  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
495  */
496 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
497 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
498 				u8 iftype)
499 {
500 	int i;
501 
502 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
503 		return NULL;
504 
505 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
506 		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
507 			&sband->iftype_data[i];
508 
509 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
510 			return data;
511 	}
512 
513 	return NULL;
514 }
515 
516 /**
517  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
518  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
519  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
520  *
521  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
522  */
523 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
524 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
525 			    u8 iftype)
526 {
527 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
528 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
529 
530 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
531 		return &data->he_cap;
532 
533 	return NULL;
534 }
535 
536 /**
537  * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA
538  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
539  *
540  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
541  */
542 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
543 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband)
544 {
545 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION);
546 }
547 
548 /**
549  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
550  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
551  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
552  *
553  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
554  */
555 static inline __le16
556 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
557 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
558 {
559 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
560 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
561 
562 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
563 		return 0;
564 
565 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
566 }
567 
568 /**
569  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
570  *
571  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
572  *
573  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
574  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
575  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
576  *
577  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
578  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
579  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
580  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
581  * without affecting other devices.
582  *
583  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
584  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
585  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
586  */
587 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
588 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
589 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
590 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
591 {
592 }
593 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
594 
595 
596 /*
597  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
598  */
599 
600 /**
601  * DOC: Actions and configuration
602  *
603  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
604  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
605  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
606  * operations use are described separately.
607  *
608  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
609  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
610  *
611  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
612  * in a separate chapter.
613  */
614 
615 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
616 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
617 
618 /**
619  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
620  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
621  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
622  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
623  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
624  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
625  *	determine the address as needed.
626  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
627  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
628  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
629  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
630  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
631  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
632  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
633  */
634 struct vif_params {
635 	u32 flags;
636 	int use_4addr;
637 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
638 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
639 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
640 };
641 
642 /**
643  * struct key_params - key information
644  *
645  * Information about a key
646  *
647  * @key: key material
648  * @key_len: length of key material
649  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
650  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
651  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
652  *	length given by @seq_len.
653  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
654  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
655  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
656  */
657 struct key_params {
658 	const u8 *key;
659 	const u8 *seq;
660 	int key_len;
661 	int seq_len;
662 	u16 vlan_id;
663 	u32 cipher;
664 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
665 };
666 
667 /**
668  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
669  * @chan: the (control) channel
670  * @width: channel width
671  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
672  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
673  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
674  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
675  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
676  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
677  *	parameters are ignored.
678  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
679  */
680 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
681 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
682 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
683 	u32 center_freq1;
684 	u32 center_freq2;
685 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
686 	u16 freq1_offset;
687 };
688 
689 /*
690  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
691  */
692 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
693 	struct {
694 		u32 legacy;
695 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
696 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
697 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
698 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
699 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
700 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
701 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
702 };
703 
704 
705 /**
706  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
707  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
708  *	of the peer.
709  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
710  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
711  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
712  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
713  * @retry_long: retry count value
714  * @retry_short: retry count value
715  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
716  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
717  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
718  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
719  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
720  */
721 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
722 	bool config_override;
723 	u8 tids;
724 	u64 mask;
725 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
726 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
727 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
728 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
729 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
730 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
731 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
732 };
733 
734 /**
735  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
736  * @peer: Station's MAC address
737  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
738  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
739  */
740 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
741 	const u8 *peer;
742 	u32 n_tid_conf;
743 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
744 };
745 
746 /**
747  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
748  * @chandef: the channel definition
749  *
750  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
751  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
752  */
753 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
754 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
755 {
756 	switch (chandef->width) {
757 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
758 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
759 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
760 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
761 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
762 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
763 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
764 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
765 	default:
766 		WARN_ON(1);
767 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
768 	}
769 }
770 
771 /**
772  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
773  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
774  * @channel: the control channel
775  * @chantype: the channel type
776  *
777  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
778  */
779 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
780 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
781 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
782 
783 /**
784  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
785  * @chandef1: first channel definition
786  * @chandef2: second channel definition
787  *
788  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
789  * identical, %false otherwise.
790  */
791 static inline bool
792 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
793 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
794 {
795 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
796 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
797 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
798 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
799 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
800 }
801 
802 /**
803  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
804  *
805  * @chandef: the channel definition
806  *
807  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
808  */
809 static inline bool
810 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
811 {
812 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
813 }
814 
815 /**
816  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
817  * @chandef1: first channel definition
818  * @chandef2: second channel definition
819  *
820  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
821  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
822  */
823 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
824 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
825 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
826 
827 /**
828  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
829  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
830  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
831  */
832 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
833 
834 /**
835  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
836  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
837  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
838  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
839  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
840  */
841 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
842 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
843 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
844 
845 /**
846  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
847  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
848  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
849  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
850  * Returns:
851  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
852  */
853 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
854 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
855 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
856 
857 /**
858  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
859  *
860  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
861  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
862  *
863  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
864  *
865  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
866  */
867 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
868 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
869 {
870 	switch (chandef->width) {
871 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
872 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
873 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
874 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
875 	default:
876 		break;
877 	}
878 	return 0;
879 }
880 
881 /**
882  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
883  *
884  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
885  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
886  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
887  *
888  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
889  *
890  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
891  */
892 static inline int
893 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
894 {
895 	switch (chandef->width) {
896 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
897 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
898 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
899 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
900 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
901 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
902 	default:
903 		break;
904 	}
905 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
906 }
907 
908 /**
909  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
910  *
911  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
912  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
913  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
914  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
915  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
916  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
917  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
918  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
919  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
920  *
921  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
922  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
923  */
924 enum survey_info_flags {
925 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
926 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
927 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
928 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
929 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
930 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
931 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
932 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
933 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
934 };
935 
936 /**
937  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
938  *
939  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
940  *	record to report global statistics
941  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
942  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
943  *	optional
944  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
945  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
946  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
947  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
948  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
949  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
950  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
951  *
952  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
953  *
954  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
955  * channel duty cycle etc.
956  */
957 struct survey_info {
958 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
959 	u64 time;
960 	u64 time_busy;
961 	u64 time_ext_busy;
962 	u64 time_rx;
963 	u64 time_tx;
964 	u64 time_scan;
965 	u64 time_bss_rx;
966 	u32 filled;
967 	s8 noise;
968 };
969 
970 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
971 
972 /**
973  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
974  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
975  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
976  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
977  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
978  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
979  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
980  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
981  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
982  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
983  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
984  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
985  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
986  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
987  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
988  *	protocol frames.
989  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
990  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
991  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
992  *	port for mac80211
993  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
994  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
995  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
996  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
997  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
998  *	offload)
999  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1000  */
1001 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1002 	u32 wpa_versions;
1003 	u32 cipher_group;
1004 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1005 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1006 	int n_akm_suites;
1007 	u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
1008 	bool control_port;
1009 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1010 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1011 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1012 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1013 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1014 	int wep_tx_key;
1015 	const u8 *psk;
1016 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1017 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1018 };
1019 
1020 /**
1021  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1022  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1023  *	or %NULL if not changed
1024  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1025  *	or %NULL if not changed
1026  * @head_len: length of @head
1027  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1028  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1029  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1030  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1031  *	frames or %NULL
1032  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1033  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1034  *	Response frames or %NULL
1035  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1036  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1037  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1038  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1039  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1040  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1041  *	(measurement type 8)
1042  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1043  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1044  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1045  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1046  */
1047 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1048 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1049 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1050 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1051 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1052 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1053 	const u8 *lci;
1054 	const u8 *civicloc;
1055 	s8 ftm_responder;
1056 
1057 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1058 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1059 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1060 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1061 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1062 	size_t lci_len;
1063 	size_t civicloc_len;
1064 };
1065 
1066 struct mac_address {
1067 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1068 };
1069 
1070 /**
1071  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1072  *
1073  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1074  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1075  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1076  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1077  */
1078 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1079 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1080 	int n_acl_entries;
1081 
1082 	/* Keep it last */
1083 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1084 };
1085 
1086 /**
1087  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1088  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1089  *
1090  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1091  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1092  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1093  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1094  *	frame headers.
1095  */
1096 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1097 	u32 min_interval;
1098 	u32 max_interval;
1099 	size_t tmpl_len;
1100 	const u8 *tmpl;
1101 };
1102 
1103 /**
1104  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1105  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1106  *
1107  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1108  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1109  *	scanning
1110  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1111  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1112  */
1113 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1114 	u32 interval;
1115 	size_t tmpl_len;
1116 	const u8 *tmpl;
1117 };
1118 
1119 /**
1120  * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
1121  *
1122  * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
1123  *
1124  * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
1125  */
1126 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
1127 	AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
1128 };
1129 
1130 /**
1131  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1132  *
1133  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1134  *
1135  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1136  * @beacon: beacon data
1137  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1138  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1139  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1140  *	user space)
1141  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1142  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1143  * @crypto: crypto settings
1144  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1145  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1146  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1147  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1148  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1149  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1150  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1151  *	MAC address based access control
1152  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1153  *	networks.
1154  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1155  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1156  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1157  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1158  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1159  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1160  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1161  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1162  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1163  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1164  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1165  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1166  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1167  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1168  */
1169 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1170 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1171 
1172 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1173 
1174 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1175 	const u8 *ssid;
1176 	size_t ssid_len;
1177 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1178 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1179 	bool privacy;
1180 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1181 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1182 	int inactivity_timeout;
1183 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1184 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1185 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1186 	bool pbss;
1187 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1188 
1189 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1190 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1191 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1192 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1193 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required;
1194 	bool twt_responder;
1195 	u32 flags;
1196 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1197 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1198 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1199 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1200 };
1201 
1202 /**
1203  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1204  *
1205  * Used for channel switch
1206  *
1207  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1208  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1209  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1210  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1211  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1212  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1213  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1214  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1215  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1216  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1217  */
1218 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1219 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1220 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1221 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1222 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1223 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1224 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1225 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1226 	bool radar_required;
1227 	bool block_tx;
1228 	u8 count;
1229 };
1230 
1231 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10
1232 
1233 /**
1234  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1235  *
1236  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1237  *
1238  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1239  *	to use for verification
1240  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1241  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1242  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1243  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1244  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1245  *	nl80211_iftype.
1246  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1247  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1248  *	the verification
1249  */
1250 struct iface_combination_params {
1251 	int num_different_channels;
1252 	u8 radar_detect;
1253 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1254 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1255 };
1256 
1257 /**
1258  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1259  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1260  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1261  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1262  *
1263  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1264  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1265  */
1266 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1267 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1268 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1269 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1270 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1271 };
1272 
1273 /**
1274  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1275  *
1276  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1277  *
1278  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1279  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1280  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1281  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1282  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1283  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1284  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1285  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1286  *	per peer TPC.
1287  */
1288 struct sta_txpwr {
1289 	s16 power;
1290 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1291 };
1292 
1293 /**
1294  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1295  *
1296  * Used to change and create a new station.
1297  *
1298  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1299  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1300  *	(or NULL for no change)
1301  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1302  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1303  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1304  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1305  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1306  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1307  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1308  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1309  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1310  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1311  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1312  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1313  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1314  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1315  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1316  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1317  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1318  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1319  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1320  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1321  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1322  *	to unknown)
1323  * @capability: station capability
1324  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1325  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1326  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1327  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1328  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1329  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1330  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1331  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1332  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1333  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1334  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1335  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1336  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1337  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1338  */
1339 struct station_parameters {
1340 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1341 	struct net_device *vlan;
1342 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1343 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1344 	int listen_interval;
1345 	u16 aid;
1346 	u16 vlan_id;
1347 	u16 peer_aid;
1348 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1349 	u8 plink_action;
1350 	u8 plink_state;
1351 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1352 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1353 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1354 	u8 max_sp;
1355 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1356 	u16 capability;
1357 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1358 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1359 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1360 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1361 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1362 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1363 	u8 opmode_notif;
1364 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1365 	int support_p2p_ps;
1366 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1367 	u8 he_capa_len;
1368 	u16 airtime_weight;
1369 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1370 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1371 };
1372 
1373 /**
1374  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1375  *
1376  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1377  *
1378  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1379  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1380  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1381  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1382  */
1383 struct station_del_parameters {
1384 	const u8 *mac;
1385 	u8 subtype;
1386 	u16 reason_code;
1387 };
1388 
1389 /**
1390  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1391  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1392  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1393  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1394  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1395  *	the AP MLME in the device
1396  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1397  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1398  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1399  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1400  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1401  *	supported/used)
1402  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1403  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1404  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1405  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1406  */
1407 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1408 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1409 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1410 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1411 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1412 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1413 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1414 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1415 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1416 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1417 };
1418 
1419 /**
1420  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1421  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1422  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1423  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1424  *
1425  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1426  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1427  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1428  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1429  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1430  */
1431 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1432 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1433 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1434 
1435 /**
1436  * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags
1437  *
1438  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1439  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1440  *
1441  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1442  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1443  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1444  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1445  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1446  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1447  */
1448 enum rate_info_flags {
1449 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1450 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1451 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1452 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1453 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1454 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1455 };
1456 
1457 /**
1458  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1459  *
1460  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1461  *
1462  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1463  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1464  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1465  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1466  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1467  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1468  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1469  */
1470 enum rate_info_bw {
1471 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1472 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1473 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1474 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1475 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1476 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1477 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1478 };
1479 
1480 /**
1481  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1482  *
1483  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1484  *
1485  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1486  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1487  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1488  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1489  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1490  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1491  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1492  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1493  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1494  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1495  */
1496 struct rate_info {
1497 	u8 flags;
1498 	u8 mcs;
1499 	u16 legacy;
1500 	u8 nss;
1501 	u8 bw;
1502 	u8 he_gi;
1503 	u8 he_dcm;
1504 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1505 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1506 };
1507 
1508 /**
1509  * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags
1510  *
1511  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1512  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1513  *
1514  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1515  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1516  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1517  */
1518 enum bss_param_flags {
1519 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1520 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1521 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1522 };
1523 
1524 /**
1525  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1526  *
1527  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1528  *
1529  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1530  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1531  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1532  */
1533 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1534 	u8 flags;
1535 	u8 dtim_period;
1536 	u16 beacon_interval;
1537 };
1538 
1539 /**
1540  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1541  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1542  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1543  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1544  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1545  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1546  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1547  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1548  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1549  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1550  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1551  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1552  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1553  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1554  */
1555 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1556 	u32 filled;
1557 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1558 	u32 backlog_packets;
1559 	u32 flows;
1560 	u32 drops;
1561 	u32 ecn_marks;
1562 	u32 overlimit;
1563 	u32 overmemory;
1564 	u32 collisions;
1565 	u32 tx_bytes;
1566 	u32 tx_packets;
1567 	u32 max_flows;
1568 };
1569 
1570 /**
1571  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1572  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1573  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1574  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1575  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1576  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1577  *	transmitted MSDUs
1578  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1579  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1580  */
1581 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1582 	u32 filled;
1583 	u64 rx_msdu;
1584 	u64 tx_msdu;
1585 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1586 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1587 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1588 };
1589 
1590 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1591 
1592 /**
1593  * struct station_info - station information
1594  *
1595  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1596  *
1597  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1598  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1599  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1600  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1601  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1602  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1603  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1604  * @llid: mesh local link id
1605  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1606  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1607  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1608  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1609  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1610  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1611  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1612  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1613  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1614  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1615  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1616  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1617  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1618  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1619  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1620  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1621  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1622  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1623  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1624  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1625  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1626  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1627  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1628  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1629  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1630  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1631  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1632  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1633  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1634  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1635  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1636  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1637  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1638  *	towards this station.
1639  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1640  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1641  *	from this peer
1642  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1643  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1644  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1645  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1646  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1647  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1648  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1649  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1650  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1651  *	been sent.
1652  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1653  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1654  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1655  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1656  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1657  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1658  */
1659 struct station_info {
1660 	u64 filled;
1661 	u32 connected_time;
1662 	u32 inactive_time;
1663 	u64 assoc_at;
1664 	u64 rx_bytes;
1665 	u64 tx_bytes;
1666 	u16 llid;
1667 	u16 plid;
1668 	u8 plink_state;
1669 	s8 signal;
1670 	s8 signal_avg;
1671 
1672 	u8 chains;
1673 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1674 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1675 
1676 	struct rate_info txrate;
1677 	struct rate_info rxrate;
1678 	u32 rx_packets;
1679 	u32 tx_packets;
1680 	u32 tx_retries;
1681 	u32 tx_failed;
1682 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1683 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1684 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1685 
1686 	int generation;
1687 
1688 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1689 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1690 
1691 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1692 	s64 t_offset;
1693 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1694 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1695 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1696 
1697 	u32 expected_throughput;
1698 
1699 	u64 tx_duration;
1700 	u64 rx_duration;
1701 	u64 rx_beacon;
1702 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1703 	u8 connected_to_gate;
1704 
1705 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1706 	s8 ack_signal;
1707 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1708 
1709 	u16 airtime_weight;
1710 
1711 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1712 	u32 fcs_err_count;
1713 
1714 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1715 
1716 	u8 connected_to_as;
1717 };
1718 
1719 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1720 /**
1721  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1722  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1723  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1724  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1725  *
1726  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1727  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1728  * considered undefined.
1729  */
1730 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1731 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
1732 #else
1733 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1734 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
1735 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
1736 {
1737 	return -ENOENT;
1738 }
1739 #endif
1740 
1741 /**
1742  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1743  *
1744  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1745  * according to the nl80211 flags.
1746  *
1747  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1748  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1749  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1750  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1751  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1752  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1753  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1754  */
1755 enum monitor_flags {
1756 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1757 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1758 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1759 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1760 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1761 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1762 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1763 };
1764 
1765 /**
1766  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
1767  *
1768  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1769  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1770  *
1771  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1772  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1773  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1774  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1775  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1776  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1777  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1778  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1779  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1780  */
1781 enum mpath_info_flags {
1782 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
1783 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
1784 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
1785 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
1786 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
1787 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
1788 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
1789 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
1790 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
1791 };
1792 
1793 /**
1794  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1795  *
1796  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1797  *
1798  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1799  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1800  * @sn: target sequence number
1801  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1802  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1803  * @flags: mesh path flags
1804  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1805  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1806  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1807  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1808  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1809  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1810  * @hop_count: hops to destination
1811  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1812  */
1813 struct mpath_info {
1814 	u32 filled;
1815 	u32 frame_qlen;
1816 	u32 sn;
1817 	u32 metric;
1818 	u32 exptime;
1819 	u32 discovery_timeout;
1820 	u8 discovery_retries;
1821 	u8 flags;
1822 	u8 hop_count;
1823 	u32 path_change_count;
1824 
1825 	int generation;
1826 };
1827 
1828 /**
1829  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1830  *
1831  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1832  *
1833  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1834  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1835  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1836  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1837  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1838  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1839  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1840  *	(or NULL for no change)
1841  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1842  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1843  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1844  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1845  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1846  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1847  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1848  */
1849 struct bss_parameters {
1850 	int use_cts_prot;
1851 	int use_short_preamble;
1852 	int use_short_slot_time;
1853 	const u8 *basic_rates;
1854 	u8 basic_rates_len;
1855 	int ap_isolate;
1856 	int ht_opmode;
1857 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1858 };
1859 
1860 /**
1861  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1862  *
1863  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1864  *
1865  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1866  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
1867  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1868  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1869  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1870  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1871  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1872  *	mesh interface
1873  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1874  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1875  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1876  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1877  *	elements
1878  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1879  *	detect compatible mesh peers
1880  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1881  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1882  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1883  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1884  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1885  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1886  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
1887  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1888  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1889  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1890  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1891  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1892  *	element
1893  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1894  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1895  *	element
1896  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1897  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1898  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1899  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1900  *	announcements are transmitted
1901  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1902  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1903  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1904  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1905  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1906  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
1907  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
1908  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
1909  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
1910  *	station to establish a peer link
1911  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
1912  *
1913  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1914  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
1915  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
1916  *
1917  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
1918  *	PREQs are transmitted.
1919  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
1920  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
1921  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
1922  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
1923  *	setting for new peer links.
1924  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
1925  *	after transmitting its beacon.
1926  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
1927  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
1928  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
1929  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
1930  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
1931  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
1932  *      in the mesh path table
1933  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
1934  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
1935  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
1936  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
1937  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
1938  */
1939 struct mesh_config {
1940 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
1941 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
1942 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
1943 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
1944 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
1945 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
1946 	u8 element_ttl;
1947 	bool auto_open_plinks;
1948 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
1949 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
1950 	u32 path_refresh_time;
1951 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
1952 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
1953 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
1954 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
1955 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
1956 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
1957 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
1958 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
1959 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
1960 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
1961 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
1962 	s32 rssi_threshold;
1963 	u16 ht_opmode;
1964 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
1965 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
1966 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
1967 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
1968 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
1969 	u32 plink_timeout;
1970 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
1971 };
1972 
1973 /**
1974  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
1975  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1976  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
1977  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
1978  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
1979  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
1980  * @path_metric: which metric to use
1981  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
1982  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
1983  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
1984  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
1985  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
1986  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
1987  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
1988  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
1989  * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
1990  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
1991  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1992  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
1993  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
1994  *	to operate on DFS channels.
1995  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1996  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1997  *
1998  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
1999  */
2000 struct mesh_setup {
2001 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2002 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2003 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2004 	u8 sync_method;
2005 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2006 	u8 path_metric;
2007 	u8 auth_id;
2008 	const u8 *ie;
2009 	u8 ie_len;
2010 	bool is_authenticated;
2011 	bool is_secure;
2012 	bool user_mpm;
2013 	u8 dtim_period;
2014 	u16 beacon_interval;
2015 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2016 	u32 basic_rates;
2017 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2018 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2019 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2020 };
2021 
2022 /**
2023  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2024  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2025  *
2026  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2027  */
2028 struct ocb_setup {
2029 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2030 };
2031 
2032 /**
2033  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2034  * @ac: AC identifier
2035  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2036  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2037  *	1..32767]
2038  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2039  *	1..32767]
2040  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2041  */
2042 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2043 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2044 	u16 txop;
2045 	u16 cwmin;
2046 	u16 cwmax;
2047 	u8 aifs;
2048 };
2049 
2050 /**
2051  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2052  *
2053  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2054  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2055  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2056  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2057  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2058  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2059  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2060  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2061  * in the wiphy structure.
2062  *
2063  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2064  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2065  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2066  *
2067  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2068  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2069  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2070  * to userspace.
2071  */
2072 
2073 /**
2074  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2075  * @ssid: the SSID
2076  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2077  */
2078 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2079 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2080 	u8 ssid_len;
2081 };
2082 
2083 /**
2084  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2085  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2086  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2087  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2088  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2089  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2090  *	userspace will be notified of that
2091  */
2092 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2093 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2094 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2095 	bool aborted;
2096 };
2097 
2098 /**
2099  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2100  *
2101  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2102  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2103  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2104  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2105  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2106  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2107  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2108  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2109  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2110  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2111  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2112  *	%duration field.
2113  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2114  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2115  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2116  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2117  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2118  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2119  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2120  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2121  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2122  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2123  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2124  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2125  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2126  */
2127 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2128 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2129 	int n_ssids;
2130 	u32 n_channels;
2131 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2132 	const u8 *ie;
2133 	size_t ie_len;
2134 	u16 duration;
2135 	bool duration_mandatory;
2136 	u32 flags;
2137 
2138 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2139 
2140 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2141 
2142 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2143 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2144 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2145 
2146 	/* internal */
2147 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2148 	unsigned long scan_start;
2149 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2150 	bool notified;
2151 	bool no_cck;
2152 
2153 	/* keep last */
2154 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2155 };
2156 
2157 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2158 {
2159 	int i;
2160 
2161 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2162 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2163 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2164 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2165 	}
2166 }
2167 
2168 /**
2169  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2170  *
2171  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2172  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2173  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2174  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2175  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2176  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2177  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2178  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2179  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2180  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2181  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2182  *	corresponding matchset.
2183  */
2184 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2185 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2186 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2187 	s32 rssi_thold;
2188 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2189 };
2190 
2191 /**
2192  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2193  *
2194  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2195  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2196  *	infinite loop.
2197  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2198  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2199  */
2200 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2201 	u32 interval;
2202 	u32 iterations;
2203 };
2204 
2205 /**
2206  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2207  *
2208  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2209  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2210  */
2211 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2212 	enum nl80211_band band;
2213 	s8 delta;
2214 };
2215 
2216 /**
2217  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2218  *
2219  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2220  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2221  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2222  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2223  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2224  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2225  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2226  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2227  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2228  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2229  *	(others are filtered out).
2230  *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2231  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2232  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2233  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2234  * @dev: the interface
2235  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2236  * @channels: channels to scan
2237  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2238  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2239  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2240  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2241  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2242  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2243  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2244  *	index must be executed first.
2245  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2246  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2247  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2248  *	owned by a particular socket)
2249  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2250  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2251  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2252  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2253  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2254  *	supported.
2255  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2256  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2257  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2258  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2259  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2260  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2261  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2262  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2263  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2264  *	comparisions.
2265  */
2266 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2267 	u64 reqid;
2268 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2269 	int n_ssids;
2270 	u32 n_channels;
2271 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2272 	const u8 *ie;
2273 	size_t ie_len;
2274 	u32 flags;
2275 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2276 	int n_match_sets;
2277 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2278 	u32 delay;
2279 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2280 	int n_scan_plans;
2281 
2282 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2283 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2284 
2285 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2286 	s8 relative_rssi;
2287 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2288 
2289 	/* internal */
2290 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2291 	struct net_device *dev;
2292 	unsigned long scan_start;
2293 	bool report_results;
2294 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2295 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2296 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2297 	struct list_head list;
2298 
2299 	/* keep last */
2300 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2301 };
2302 
2303 /**
2304  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2305  *
2306  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2307  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2308  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2309  */
2310 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2311 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2312 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2313 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2314 };
2315 
2316 /**
2317  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2318  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2319  * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2320  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2321  *	signal type
2322  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2323  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2324  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2325  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2326  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2327  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2328  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2329  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2330  *	by %parent_bssid.
2331  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2332  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2333  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2334  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2335  */
2336 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2337 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2338 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2339 	s32 signal;
2340 	u64 boottime_ns;
2341 	u64 parent_tsf;
2342 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2343 	u8 chains;
2344 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2345 };
2346 
2347 /**
2348  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2349  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2350  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2351  * @len: length of the IEs
2352  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2353  * @data: IE data
2354  */
2355 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2356 	u64 tsf;
2357 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2358 	int len;
2359 	bool from_beacon;
2360 	u8 data[];
2361 };
2362 
2363 /**
2364  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2365  *
2366  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2367  * for use in scan results and similar.
2368  *
2369  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2370  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2371  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2372  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2373  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2374  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2375  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2376  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2377  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2378  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2379  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2380  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2381  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2382  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2383  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2384  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2385  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2386  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2387  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2388  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2389  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2390  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2391  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2392  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2393  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2394  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2395  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2396  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2397  */
2398 struct cfg80211_bss {
2399 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2400 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2401 
2402 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2403 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2404 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2405 
2406 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2407 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2408 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2409 
2410 	s32 signal;
2411 
2412 	u16 beacon_interval;
2413 	u16 capability;
2414 
2415 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2416 	u8 chains;
2417 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2418 
2419 	u8 bssid_index;
2420 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2421 
2422 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2423 };
2424 
2425 /**
2426  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2427  * @bss: the bss to search
2428  * @id: the element ID
2429  *
2430  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2431  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2432  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2433  */
2434 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2435 
2436 /**
2437  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2438  * @bss: the bss to search
2439  * @id: the element ID
2440  *
2441  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2442  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2443  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2444  */
2445 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2446 {
2447 	return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2448 }
2449 
2450 
2451 /**
2452  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2453  *
2454  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2455  * authentication.
2456  *
2457  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2458  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2459  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2460  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2461  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2462  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2463  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2464  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2465  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2466  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2467  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2468  *	transaction sequence number field.
2469  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2470  */
2471 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2472 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2473 	const u8 *ie;
2474 	size_t ie_len;
2475 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2476 	const u8 *key;
2477 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2478 	const u8 *auth_data;
2479 	size_t auth_data_len;
2480 };
2481 
2482 /**
2483  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2484  *
2485  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2486  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2487  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2488  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2489  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2490  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2491  *	request (connect callback).
2492  */
2493 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2494 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2495 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2496 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2497 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2498 };
2499 
2500 /**
2501  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2502  *
2503  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2504  * (re)association.
2505  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2506  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2507  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2508  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2509  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2510  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2511  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2512  * @crypto: crypto settings
2513  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2514  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2515  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2516  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2517  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2518  *	frame.
2519  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2520  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2521  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2522  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2523  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2524  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2525  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2526  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2527  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2528  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2529  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2530  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2531  */
2532 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2533 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2534 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2535 	size_t ie_len;
2536 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2537 	bool use_mfp;
2538 	u32 flags;
2539 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2540 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2541 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2542 	const u8 *fils_kek;
2543 	size_t fils_kek_len;
2544 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2545 };
2546 
2547 /**
2548  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2549  *
2550  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2551  * deauthentication.
2552  *
2553  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2554  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2555  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2556  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2557  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2558  *	do not set a deauth frame
2559  */
2560 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2561 	const u8 *bssid;
2562 	const u8 *ie;
2563 	size_t ie_len;
2564 	u16 reason_code;
2565 	bool local_state_change;
2566 };
2567 
2568 /**
2569  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2570  *
2571  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2572  * disassociation.
2573  *
2574  * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2575  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2576  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2577  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2578  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2579  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2580  */
2581 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2582 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2583 	const u8 *ie;
2584 	size_t ie_len;
2585 	u16 reason_code;
2586 	bool local_state_change;
2587 };
2588 
2589 /**
2590  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2591  *
2592  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2593  * method.
2594  *
2595  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2596  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2597  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2598  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2599  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2600  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2601  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
2602  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2603  * @ie_len: length of that
2604  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2605  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2606  *	after joining
2607  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2608  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2609  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2610  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2611  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2612  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2613  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2614  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2615  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2616  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2617  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2618  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2619  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2620  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2621  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2622  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2623  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2624  */
2625 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2626 	const u8 *ssid;
2627 	const u8 *bssid;
2628 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2629 	const u8 *ie;
2630 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2631 	u16 beacon_interval;
2632 	u32 basic_rates;
2633 	bool channel_fixed;
2634 	bool privacy;
2635 	bool control_port;
2636 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2637 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2638 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2639 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2640 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2641 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
2642 	int wep_tx_key;
2643 };
2644 
2645 /**
2646  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2647  *
2648  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2649  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2650  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2651  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2652  */
2653 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2654 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2655 	union {
2656 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2657 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2658 	} param;
2659 };
2660 
2661 /**
2662  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2663  *
2664  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2665  * authentication and association.
2666  *
2667  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2668  *	on scan results)
2669  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2670  *	%NULL if not specified
2671  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2672  *	results)
2673  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2674  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2675  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2676  *	to use.
2677  * @ssid: SSID
2678  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2679  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2680  * @ie: IEs for association request
2681  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2682  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2683  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2684  * @crypto: crypto settings
2685  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2686  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2687  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2688  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2689  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
2690  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2691  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2692  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2693  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2694  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
2695  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2696  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2697  *	networks.
2698  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2699  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2700  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2701  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2702  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2703  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2704  *	frame.
2705  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2706  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2707  *	data IE.
2708  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2709  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2710  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2711  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2712  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2713  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2714  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2715  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2716  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2717  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2718  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2719  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
2720  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2721  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2722  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2723  */
2724 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2725 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2726 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2727 	const u8 *bssid;
2728 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
2729 	const u8 *ssid;
2730 	size_t ssid_len;
2731 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2732 	const u8 *ie;
2733 	size_t ie_len;
2734 	bool privacy;
2735 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2736 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2737 	const u8 *key;
2738 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2739 	u32 flags;
2740 	int bg_scan_period;
2741 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2742 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2743 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2744 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2745 	bool pbss;
2746 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2747 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
2748 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2749 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2750 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2751 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2752 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2753 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2754 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2755 	bool want_1x;
2756 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2757 };
2758 
2759 /**
2760  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2761  *
2762  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2763  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2764  *
2765  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2766  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2767  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2768  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2769  */
2770 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2771 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
2772 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
2773 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
2774 };
2775 
2776 /**
2777  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2778  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2779  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2780  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2781  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2782  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2783  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2784  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2785  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2786  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2787  */
2788 enum wiphy_params_flags {
2789 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
2790 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
2791 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
2792 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
2793 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
2794 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
2795 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
2796 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
2797 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
2798 };
2799 
2800 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
2801 
2802 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
2803 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
2804 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
2805 
2806 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
2807 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
2808 
2809 /**
2810  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2811  *
2812  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2813  * caching.
2814  *
2815  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2816  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2817  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2818  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2819  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2820  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2821  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2822  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2823  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2824  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2825  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2826  *	%NULL).
2827  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
2828  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
2829  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
2830  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
2831  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
2832  *	used for it expires.
2833  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
2834  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
2835  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
2836  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
2837  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
2838  */
2839 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2840 	const u8 *bssid;
2841 	const u8 *pmkid;
2842 	const u8 *pmk;
2843 	size_t pmk_len;
2844 	const u8 *ssid;
2845 	size_t ssid_len;
2846 	const u8 *cache_id;
2847 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
2848 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
2849 };
2850 
2851 /**
2852  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2853  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2854  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2855  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2856  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2857  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2858  *
2859  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2860  * memory, free @mask only!
2861  */
2862 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2863 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2864 	int pattern_len;
2865 	int pkt_offset;
2866 };
2867 
2868 /**
2869  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2870  *
2871  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2872  * @src: source IP address
2873  * @dst: destination IP address
2874  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
2875  * @src_port: source port
2876  * @dst_port: destination port
2877  * @payload_len: data payload length
2878  * @payload: data payload buffer
2879  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
2880  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
2881  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
2882  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
2883  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
2884  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
2885  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
2886  */
2887 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
2888 	struct socket *sock;
2889 	__be32 src, dst;
2890 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
2891 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
2892 	int payload_len;
2893 	const u8 *payload;
2894 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
2895 	u32 data_interval;
2896 	u32 wake_len;
2897 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
2898 	u32 tokens_size;
2899 	/* must be last, variable member */
2900 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
2901 };
2902 
2903 /**
2904  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
2905  *
2906  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
2907  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
2908  *	operating as normal during suspend
2909  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
2910  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
2911  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
2912  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2913  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
2914  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
2915  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
2916  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
2917  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
2918  *	NULL if not configured.
2919  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
2920  */
2921 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
2922 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
2923 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
2924 	     rfkill_release;
2925 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2926 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
2927 	int n_patterns;
2928 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
2929 };
2930 
2931 /**
2932  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
2933  *
2934  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
2935  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
2936  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
2937  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
2938  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
2939  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2940  */
2941 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
2942 	int delay;
2943 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
2944 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2945 	int n_patterns;
2946 };
2947 
2948 /**
2949  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
2950  *
2951  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
2952  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
2953  * @n_rules: number of rules
2954  */
2955 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
2956 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
2957 	int n_rules;
2958 };
2959 
2960 /**
2961  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
2962  *
2963  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
2964  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
2965  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
2966  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
2967  *	occurred (in MHz)
2968  */
2969 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
2970 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2971 	int n_channels;
2972 	u32 channels[];
2973 };
2974 
2975 /**
2976  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
2977  *
2978  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
2979  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
2980  *	match information.
2981  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
2982  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
2983  */
2984 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
2985 	int n_matches;
2986 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
2987 };
2988 
2989 /**
2990  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
2991  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
2992  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
2993  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
2994  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
2995  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
2996  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
2997  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
2998  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
2999  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3000  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3001  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3002  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3003  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3004  *	it is.
3005  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3006  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3007  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3008  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3009  */
3010 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3011 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3012 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3013 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3014 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3015 	s32 pattern_idx;
3016 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3017 	const void *packet;
3018 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3019 };
3020 
3021 /**
3022  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3023  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3024  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3025  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3026  * @kek_len: length of kek
3027  * @kck_len length of kck
3028  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3029  */
3030 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3031 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3032 	u32 akm;
3033 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3034 };
3035 
3036 /**
3037  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3038  *
3039  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3040  *
3041  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3042  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3043  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3044  */
3045 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3046 	u16 md;
3047 	const u8 *ie;
3048 	size_t ie_len;
3049 };
3050 
3051 /**
3052  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3053  *
3054  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3055  *
3056  * @chan: channel to use
3057  * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3058  * @wait: duration for ROC
3059  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3060  * @len: buffer length
3061  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3062  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3063  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3064  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3065  */
3066 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3067 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3068 	bool offchan;
3069 	unsigned int wait;
3070 	const u8 *buf;
3071 	size_t len;
3072 	bool no_cck;
3073 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3074 	int n_csa_offsets;
3075 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3076 };
3077 
3078 /**
3079  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3080  *
3081  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3082  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3083  */
3084 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3085 	u8 dscp;
3086 	u8 up;
3087 };
3088 
3089 /**
3090  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3091  *
3092  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3093  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3094  */
3095 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3096 	u8 low;
3097 	u8 high;
3098 };
3099 
3100 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3101 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3102 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3103 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3104 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3105 
3106 /**
3107  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3108  *
3109  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3110  *
3111  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3112  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3113  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3114  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3115  */
3116 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3117 	u8 num_des;
3118 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3119 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3120 };
3121 
3122 /**
3123  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3124  *
3125  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3126  *
3127  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3128  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3129  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3130  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3131  */
3132 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3133 	u8 master_pref;
3134 	u8 bands;
3135 };
3136 
3137 /**
3138  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3139  * configuration
3140  *
3141  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3142  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3143  */
3144 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3145 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3146 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3147 };
3148 
3149 /**
3150  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3151  *
3152  * @filter: the content of the filter
3153  * @len: the length of the filter
3154  */
3155 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3156 	const u8 *filter;
3157 	u8 len;
3158 };
3159 
3160 /**
3161  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3162  *
3163  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3164  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3165  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3166  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3167  *	implementation specific.
3168  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3169  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3170  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3171  * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3172  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3173  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3174  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3175  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3176  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3177  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3178  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3179  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3180  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3181  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3182  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3183  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3184  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3185  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3186  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3187  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3188  */
3189 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3190 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3191 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3192 	u8 publish_type;
3193 	bool close_range;
3194 	bool publish_bcast;
3195 	bool subscribe_active;
3196 	u8 followup_id;
3197 	u8 followup_reqid;
3198 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3199 	u32 ttl;
3200 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3201 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3202 	bool srf_include;
3203 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3204 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3205 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3206 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3207 	int srf_num_macs;
3208 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3209 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3210 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3211 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3212 	u8 instance_id;
3213 	u64 cookie;
3214 };
3215 
3216 /**
3217  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3218  *
3219  * @aa: authenticator address
3220  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3221  * @pmk: the PMK material
3222  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3223  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3224  *	holds PMK-R0.
3225  */
3226 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3227 	const u8 *aa;
3228 	u8 pmk_len;
3229 	const u8 *pmk;
3230 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3231 };
3232 
3233 /**
3234  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3235  *
3236  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3237  *
3238  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3239  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3240  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3241  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3242  *	authentication response command interface.
3243  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3244  *	authentication response command interface.
3245  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3246  *	authentication request event interface.
3247  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3248  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3249  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3250  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3251  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3252  */
3253 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3254 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3255 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3256 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3257 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3258 	u16 status;
3259 	const u8 *pmkid;
3260 };
3261 
3262 /**
3263  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3264  *
3265  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3266  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3267  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3268  *	answered
3269  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3270  *	successfully answered
3271  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3272  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3273  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3274  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3275  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3276  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3277  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3278  *	the responder
3279  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3280  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3281  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3282  */
3283 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3284 	u32 filled;
3285 	u32 success_num;
3286 	u32 partial_num;
3287 	u32 failed_num;
3288 	u32 asap_num;
3289 	u32 non_asap_num;
3290 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3291 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3292 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3293 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3294 };
3295 
3296 /**
3297  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3298  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3299  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3300  *	reason than just "failure"
3301  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3302  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3303  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3304  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3305  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3306  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3307  *	by the responder
3308  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3309  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3310  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3311  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3312  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3313  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3314  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3315  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3316  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3317  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3318  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3319  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3320  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3321  *	the square root of the variance)
3322  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3323  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3324  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3325  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3326  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3327  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3328  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3329  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3330  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3331  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3332  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3333  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3334  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3335  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3336  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3337  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3338  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3339  */
3340 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3341 	const u8 *lci;
3342 	const u8 *civicloc;
3343 	unsigned int lci_len;
3344 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3345 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3346 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3347 	s16 burst_index;
3348 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3349 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3350 	u8 burst_duration;
3351 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3352 	s32 rssi_avg;
3353 	s32 rssi_spread;
3354 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3355 	s64 rtt_avg;
3356 	s64 rtt_variance;
3357 	s64 rtt_spread;
3358 	s64 dist_avg;
3359 	s64 dist_variance;
3360 	s64 dist_spread;
3361 
3362 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3363 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3364 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3365 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3366 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3367 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3368 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3369 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3370 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3371 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3372 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3373 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3374 };
3375 
3376 /**
3377  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3378  * @addr: address of the peer
3379  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3380  *	measurement was made)
3381  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3382  * @status: status of the measurement
3383  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3384  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3385  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3386  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3387  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3388  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3389  */
3390 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3391 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3392 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3393 
3394 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3395 
3396 	u8 final:1,
3397 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3398 
3399 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3400 
3401 	union {
3402 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3403 	};
3404 };
3405 
3406 /**
3407  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3408  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3409  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3410  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3411  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3412  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3413  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3414  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3415  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3416  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3417  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3418  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3419  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3420  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3421  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3422  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3423  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3424  *
3425  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3426  */
3427 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3428 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3429 	u16 burst_period;
3430 	u8 requested:1,
3431 	   asap:1,
3432 	   request_lci:1,
3433 	   request_civicloc:1,
3434 	   trigger_based:1,
3435 	   non_trigger_based:1;
3436 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3437 	u8 burst_duration;
3438 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3439 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3440 };
3441 
3442 /**
3443  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3444  * @addr: MAC address
3445  * @chandef: channel to use
3446  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3447  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3448  */
3449 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3450 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3451 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3452 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3453 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3454 };
3455 
3456 /**
3457  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3458  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3459  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3460  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3461  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3462  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3463  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3464  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3465  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3466  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3467  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3468  *	zero it means there's no timeout
3469  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3470  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3471  */
3472 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3473 	u64 cookie;
3474 	void *drv_data;
3475 	u32 n_peers;
3476 	u32 nl_portid;
3477 
3478 	u32 timeout;
3479 
3480 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3481 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3482 
3483 	struct list_head list;
3484 
3485 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3486 };
3487 
3488 /**
3489  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3490  *
3491  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3492  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3493  *
3494  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3495  *
3496  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3497  *	has to be done.
3498  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3499  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3500  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3501  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3502  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3503  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3504  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3505  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3506  */
3507 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3508 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3509 	u16 status;
3510 	const u8 *ie;
3511 	size_t ie_len;
3512 };
3513 
3514 /**
3515  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3516  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3517  *	for the entire device
3518  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3519  *	for the given interface
3520  * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3521  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3522  *	for these subtypes
3523  */
3524 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3525 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3526 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3527 };
3528 
3529 /**
3530  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3531  *
3532  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3533  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3534  *
3535  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3536  * on success or a negative error code.
3537  *
3538  * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the
3539  * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this
3540  * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext.
3541  *
3542  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3543  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3544  *	configured for the device.
3545  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3546  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3547  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3548  *	the device.
3549  *
3550  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3551  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3552  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3553  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3554  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
3555  *
3556  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3557  *
3558  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3559  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3560  *
3561  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3562  *	when adding a group key.
3563  *
3564  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3565  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3566  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3567  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3568  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
3569  *
3570  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3571  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
3572  *
3573  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
3574  *
3575  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
3576  *
3577  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface
3578  *
3579  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3580  *
3581  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3582  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3583  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3584  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3585  *
3586  * @add_station: Add a new station.
3587  * @del_station: Remove a station
3588  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3589  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3590  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3591  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3592  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3593  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3594  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3595  *
3596  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3597  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3598  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3599  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3600  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3601  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3602  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3603  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3604  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3605  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3606  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3607  *
3608  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3609  *
3610  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3611  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3612  *	set, and which to leave alone.
3613  *
3614  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3615  *
3616  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3617  *
3618  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3619  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3620  *	join the mesh instead.
3621  *
3622  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3623  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3624  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3625  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3626  *
3627  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3628  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3629  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3630  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3631  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3632  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3633  *
3634  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3635  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3636  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3637  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3638  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3639  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3640  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3641  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3642  *
3643  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3644  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3645  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3646  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3647  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3648  *	was received.
3649  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3650  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3651  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3652  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3653  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
3654  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3655  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3656  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3657  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
3658  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3659  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3660  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3661  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3662  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3663  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3664  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3665  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3666  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3667  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3668  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3669  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3670  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3671  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
3672  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3673  *
3674  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3675  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3676  *	to a merge.
3677  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3678  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3679  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3680  *
3681  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3682  *	MESH mode)
3683  *
3684  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3685  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3686  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3687  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3688  *
3689  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3690  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3691  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3692  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3693  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3694  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3695  *	return 0 if successful
3696  *
3697  * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface
3698  *
3699  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3700  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3701  *
3702  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3703  *
3704  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3705  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3706  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3707  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3708  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3709  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3710  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3711  *	the duration value.
3712  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3713  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3714  *	frame on another channel
3715  *
3716  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3717  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3718  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3719  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3720  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3721  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3722  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3723  *
3724  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3725  *
3726  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3727  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3728  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3729  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3730  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3731  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3732  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3733  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3734  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3735  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3736  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3737  *	disabled.)
3738  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3739  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
3740  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
3741  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3742  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3743  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3744  *	thresholds.
3745  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3746  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3747  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3748  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3749  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3750  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3751  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
3752  *
3753  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
3754  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3755  *
3756  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3757  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3758  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3759  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3760  *
3761  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3762  *
3763  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3764  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3765  *
3766  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3767  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3768  *
3769  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3770  *
3771  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3772  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3773  *	current monitoring channel.
3774  *
3775  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3776  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3777  *
3778  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3779  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3780  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3781  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3782  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3783  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3784  *
3785  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3786  *
3787  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3788  *	was finished on another phy.
3789  *
3790  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3791  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3792  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3793  *
3794  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3795  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3796  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3797  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3798  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
3799  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3800  *
3801  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3802  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3803  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3804  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3805  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3806  *	as soon as possible.
3807  *
3808  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3809  *
3810  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3811  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3812  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3813  *
3814  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3815  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3816  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3817  *	account.
3818  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3819  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3820  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3821  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3822  *	rejected)
3823  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3824  *
3825  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3826  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3827  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3828  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3829  *
3830  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3831  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3832  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3833  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3834  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3835  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3836  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3837  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3838  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3839  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3840  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3841  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3842  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3843  *	provided @nan_func.
3844  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3845  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3846  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3847  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
3848  *
3849  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3850  *
3851  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3852  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3853  *
3854  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3855  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3856  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
3857  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3858  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3859  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3860  *
3861  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3862  *     user space
3863  *
3864  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
3865  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
3866  *
3867  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3868  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3869  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
3870  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
3871  *
3872  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
3873  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
3874  *	DH IE through this interface.
3875  *
3876  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
3877  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
3878  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
3879  *	This callback may sleep.
3880  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
3881  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
3882  */
3883 struct cfg80211_ops {
3884 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
3885 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3886 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
3887 
3888 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3889 						  const char *name,
3890 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
3891 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
3892 						  struct vif_params *params);
3893 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3894 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3895 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3896 				       struct net_device *dev,
3897 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
3898 				       struct vif_params *params);
3899 
3900 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3901 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3902 			   struct key_params *params);
3903 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3904 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3905 			   void *cookie,
3906 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
3907 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3908 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
3909 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3910 				   struct net_device *netdev,
3911 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
3912 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3913 					struct net_device *netdev,
3914 					u8 key_index);
3915 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3916 					  struct net_device *netdev,
3917 					  u8 key_index);
3918 
3919 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3920 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
3921 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3922 				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
3923 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3924 
3925 
3926 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3927 			       const u8 *mac,
3928 			       struct station_parameters *params);
3929 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3930 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
3931 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3932 				  const u8 *mac,
3933 				  struct station_parameters *params);
3934 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3935 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3936 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3937 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3938 
3939 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3940 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3941 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3942 			       const u8 *dst);
3943 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3944 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3945 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3946 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3947 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3948 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
3949 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3950 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3951 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3952 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3953 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
3954 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3955 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3956 				struct net_device *dev,
3957 				struct mesh_config *conf);
3958 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3959 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
3960 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
3961 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3962 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
3963 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
3964 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3965 
3966 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3967 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
3968 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3969 
3970 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3971 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
3972 
3973 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3974 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
3975 
3976 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3977 					     struct net_device *dev,
3978 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
3979 
3980 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3981 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3982 
3983 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3984 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
3985 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3986 
3987 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3988 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
3989 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3990 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
3991 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3992 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
3993 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3994 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
3995 
3996 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3997 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
3998 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3999 					 struct net_device *dev,
4000 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4001 					 u32 changed);
4002 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4003 			      u16 reason_code);
4004 
4005 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4006 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4007 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4008 
4009 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4010 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4011 
4012 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4013 
4014 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4015 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4016 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4017 				int *dbm);
4018 
4019 	int	(*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4020 				const u8 *addr);
4021 
4022 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4023 
4024 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4025 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4026 				void *data, int len);
4027 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4028 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4029 				 void *data, int len);
4030 #endif
4031 
4032 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4033 				    struct net_device *dev,
4034 				    const u8 *peer,
4035 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4036 
4037 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4038 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4039 
4040 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4041 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4042 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4043 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4044 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4045 
4046 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4047 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4048 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4049 				     unsigned int duration,
4050 				     u64 *cookie);
4051 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4052 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4053 					    u64 cookie);
4054 
4055 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4056 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4057 			   u64 *cookie);
4058 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4059 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4060 				       u64 cookie);
4061 
4062 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4063 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4064 
4065 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4066 				       struct net_device *dev,
4067 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4068 
4069 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4070 					     struct net_device *dev,
4071 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4072 
4073 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4074 				      struct net_device *dev,
4075 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4076 
4077 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4078 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4079 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4080 
4081 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4082 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4083 
4084 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4085 				struct net_device *dev,
4086 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4087 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4088 				   u64 reqid);
4089 
4090 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4091 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4092 
4093 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4094 			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4095 			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4096 			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4097 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4098 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4099 
4100 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4101 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4102 
4103 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4104 				  struct net_device *dev,
4105 				  u16 noack_map);
4106 
4107 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4108 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4109 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4110 
4111 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4112 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4113 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4114 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4115 
4116 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4117 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4118 
4119 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4120 					 struct net_device *dev,
4121 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4122 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4123 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4124 				struct net_device *dev);
4125 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4126 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4127 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4128 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4129 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4130 				    u16 duration);
4131 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4132 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4133 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4134 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4135 
4136 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4137 				  struct net_device *dev,
4138 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4139 
4140 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4141 			       struct net_device *dev,
4142 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4143 
4144 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4145 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4146 
4147 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4148 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4149 			     u16 admitted_time);
4150 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4151 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4152 
4153 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4154 				       struct net_device *dev,
4155 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4156 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4157 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4158 					      struct net_device *dev,
4159 					      const u8 *addr);
4160 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4161 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4162 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4163 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4164 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4165 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4166 			       u64 cookie);
4167 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4168 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4169 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4170 				   u32 changes);
4171 
4172 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4173 					    struct net_device *dev,
4174 					    const bool enabled);
4175 
4176 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4177 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4178 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4179 
4180 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4181 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4182 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4183 			   const u8 *aa);
4184 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4185 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4186 
4187 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4188 				   struct net_device *dev,
4189 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4190 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4191 				   const bool noencrypt,
4192 				   u64 *cookie);
4193 
4194 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4195 				struct net_device *dev,
4196 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4197 
4198 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4199 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4200 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4201 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4202 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4203 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4204 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4205 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4206 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4207 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4208 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4209 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4210 };
4211 
4212 /*
4213  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4214  * and registration/helper functions
4215  */
4216 
4217 /**
4218  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4219  *
4220  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4221  *	wiphy at all
4222  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4223  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4224  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4225  *	reason to override the default
4226  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4227  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4228  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4229  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4230  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4231  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4232  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4233  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4234  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4235  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4236  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4237  *	firmware.
4238  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4239  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4240  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4241  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4242  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4243  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4244  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4245  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4246  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4247  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4248  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4249  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4250  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4251  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4252  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4253  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4254  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4255  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4256  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4257  *	before connection.
4258  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4259  */
4260 enum wiphy_flags {
4261 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4262 	/* use hole at 1 */
4263 	/* use hole at 2 */
4264 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4265 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4266 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4267 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4268 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4269 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4270 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4271 	/* use hole at 11 */
4272 	/* use hole at 12 */
4273 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4274 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4275 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4276 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4277 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4278 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4279 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4280 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4281 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4282 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4283 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4284 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
4285 };
4286 
4287 /**
4288  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4289  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4290  * @types: interface types (bits)
4291  */
4292 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4293 	u16 max;
4294 	u16 types;
4295 };
4296 
4297 /**
4298  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4299  *
4300  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4301  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4302  *
4303  * Examples:
4304  *
4305  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4306  *
4307  *    .. code-block:: c
4308  *
4309  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4310  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4311  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4312  *	};
4313  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4314  *		.limits = limits1,
4315  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4316  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4317  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4318  *	};
4319  *
4320  *
4321  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4322  *
4323  *    .. code-block:: c
4324  *
4325  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4326  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4327  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4328  *	};
4329  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4330  *		.limits = limits2,
4331  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4332  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4333  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4334  *	};
4335  *
4336  *
4337  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4338  *
4339  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4340  *
4341  *    .. code-block:: c
4342  *
4343  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4344  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4345  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4346  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4347  *	};
4348  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4349  *		.limits = limits3,
4350  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4351  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4352  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4353  *	};
4354  *
4355  */
4356 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4357 	/**
4358 	 * @limits:
4359 	 * limits for the given interface types
4360 	 */
4361 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4362 
4363 	/**
4364 	 * @num_different_channels:
4365 	 * can use up to this many different channels
4366 	 */
4367 	u32 num_different_channels;
4368 
4369 	/**
4370 	 * @max_interfaces:
4371 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4372 	 */
4373 	u16 max_interfaces;
4374 
4375 	/**
4376 	 * @n_limits:
4377 	 * number of limitations
4378 	 */
4379 	u8 n_limits;
4380 
4381 	/**
4382 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4383 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4384 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4385 	 */
4386 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4387 
4388 	/**
4389 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4390 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4391 	 */
4392 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4393 
4394 	/**
4395 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4396 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4397 	 */
4398 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4399 
4400 	/**
4401 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4402 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4403 	 *
4404 	 * = 0
4405 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4406 	 * > 0
4407 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4408 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4409 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4410 	 */
4411 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4412 };
4413 
4414 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4415 	u16 tx, rx;
4416 };
4417 
4418 /**
4419  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4420  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4421  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4422  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4423  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4424  *	packet should be preserved in that case
4425  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4426  *	(see nl80211.h)
4427  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4428  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4429  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4430  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4431  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4432  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4433  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4434  */
4435 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4436 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4437 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4438 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4439 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4440 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4441 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4442 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4443 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4444 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4445 };
4446 
4447 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4448 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4449 	u32 data_payload_max;
4450 	u32 data_interval_max;
4451 	u32 wake_payload_max;
4452 	bool seq;
4453 };
4454 
4455 /**
4456  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4457  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4458  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4459  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4460  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4461  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4462  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4463  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4464  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4465  *	scheduled scans.
4466  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4467  *	details.
4468  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4469  */
4470 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4471 	u32 flags;
4472 	int n_patterns;
4473 	int pattern_max_len;
4474 	int pattern_min_len;
4475 	int max_pkt_offset;
4476 	int max_nd_match_sets;
4477 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4478 };
4479 
4480 /**
4481  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4482  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4483  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4484  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4485  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4486  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4487  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4488  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4489  */
4490 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4491 	int n_rules;
4492 	int max_delay;
4493 	int n_patterns;
4494 	int pattern_max_len;
4495 	int pattern_min_len;
4496 	int max_pkt_offset;
4497 };
4498 
4499 /**
4500  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4501  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4502  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4503  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4504  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4505  */
4506 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4507 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4508 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4509 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4510 };
4511 
4512 /**
4513  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4514  *
4515  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4516  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4517  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4518  *
4519  */
4520 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4521 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
4522 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
4523 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
4524 };
4525 
4526 /**
4527  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4528  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4529  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4530  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4531  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4532  */
4533 
4534 struct sta_opmode_info {
4535 	u32 changed;
4536 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4537 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4538 	u8 rx_nss;
4539 };
4540 
4541 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4542 
4543 /**
4544  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4545  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4546  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4547  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4548  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4549  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4550  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4551  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4552  *	dumpit calls.
4553  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4554  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4555  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4556  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4557  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4558  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4559  * are used with dump requests.
4560  */
4561 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4562 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4563 	u32 flags;
4564 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4565 		    const void *data, int data_len);
4566 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4567 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4568 		      unsigned long *storage);
4569 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
4570 	unsigned int maxattr;
4571 };
4572 
4573 /**
4574  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4575  * @iftype: interface type
4576  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4577  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4578  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4579  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4580  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4581  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4582  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4583  */
4584 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4585 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4586 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4587 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4588 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4589 };
4590 
4591 /**
4592  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4593  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4594  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4595  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
4596  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4597  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4598  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4599  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4600  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4601  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4602  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4603  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4604  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4605  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4606  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4607  *	not limited)
4608  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4609  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4610  */
4611 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4612 	unsigned int max_peers;
4613 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4614 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
4615 
4616 	struct {
4617 		u32 preambles;
4618 		u32 bandwidths;
4619 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4620 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4621 		u8 supported:1,
4622 		   asap:1,
4623 		   non_asap:1,
4624 		   request_lci:1,
4625 		   request_civicloc:1,
4626 		   trigger_based:1,
4627 		   non_trigger_based:1;
4628 	} ftm;
4629 };
4630 
4631 /**
4632  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
4633  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
4634  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
4635  *
4636  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
4637  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
4638  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4639  */
4640 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
4641 	u16 iftypes_mask;
4642 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4643 	int n_akm_suites;
4644 };
4645 
4646 /**
4647  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4648  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4649  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4650  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4651  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4652  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4653  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4654  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4655  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4656  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4657  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4658  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
4659  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
4660  *	iftype_akm_suites.
4661  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4662  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
4663  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
4664  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
4665  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
4666  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
4667  *	suites are specified separately.
4668  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4669  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4670  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4671  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4672  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4673  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4674  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4675  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4676  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4677  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4678  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4679  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4680  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4681  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4682  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4683  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4684  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4685  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4686  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4687  *	unregister hardware
4688  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
4689  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
4690  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
4691  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
4692  *	(see below).
4693  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4694  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4695  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4696  *	must be set by driver
4697  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4698  *	list single interface types.
4699  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4700  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4701  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4702  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4703  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4704  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4705  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4706  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4707  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4708  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4709  *	this variable determines its size
4710  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4711  *	any given scan
4712  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4713  *	the device can run concurrently.
4714  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4715  *	for in any given scheduled scan
4716  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4717  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4718  *	supported.
4719  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4720  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4721  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
4722  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4723  *	scans
4724  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4725  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4726  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4727  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
4728  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4729  *	scan plan supported by the device.
4730  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4731  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4732  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4733  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4734  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4735  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4736  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4737  *
4738  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4739  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4740  *	type
4741  *
4742  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4743  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4744  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4745  *
4746  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4747  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4748  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4749  *
4750  * @probe_resp_offload:
4751  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4752  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4753  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4754  *
4755  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4756  *	may request, if implemented.
4757  *
4758  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4759  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4760  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4761  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
4762  *
4763  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4764  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4765  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4766  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4767  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4768  *
4769  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4770  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4771  *
4772  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4773  *	supports for ACL.
4774  *
4775  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4776  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4777  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4778  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4779  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4780  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4781  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4782  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4783  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4784  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4785  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4786  *	capabilities are specified separately.
4787  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4788  *
4789  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4790  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4791  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4792  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4793  *
4794  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4795  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4796  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4797  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
4798  *
4799  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4800  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
4801  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4802  *	infinite.
4803  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4804  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4805  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4806  *
4807  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4808  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
4809  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4810  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4811  *
4812  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4813  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4814  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4815  *
4816  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
4817  *	wake_tx_queue
4818  *
4819  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4820  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4821  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4822  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4823  *
4824  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4825  *
4826  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
4827  *	device has
4828  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4829  *	supported by the driver for each vif
4830  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4831  *	supported by the driver for each peer
4832  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
4833  *	long/short retry configuration
4834  *
4835  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
4836  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
4837  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
4838  */
4839 struct wiphy {
4840 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4841 
4842 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4843 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4844 
4845 	struct mac_address *addresses;
4846 
4847 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4848 
4849 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4850 	int n_iface_combinations;
4851 	u16 software_iftypes;
4852 
4853 	u16 n_addresses;
4854 
4855 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
4856 	u16 interface_modes;
4857 
4858 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
4859 
4860 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
4861 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
4862 
4863 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
4864 
4865 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
4866 
4867 	int bss_priv_size;
4868 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
4869 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
4870 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
4871 	u8 max_match_sets;
4872 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
4873 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
4874 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
4875 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
4876 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
4877 
4878 	int n_cipher_suites;
4879 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
4880 
4881 	int n_akm_suites;
4882 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4883 
4884 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
4885 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
4886 
4887 	u8 retry_short;
4888 	u8 retry_long;
4889 	u32 frag_threshold;
4890 	u32 rts_threshold;
4891 	u8 coverage_class;
4892 
4893 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
4894 	u32 hw_version;
4895 
4896 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4897 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
4898 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
4899 #endif
4900 
4901 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
4902 
4903 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
4904 
4905 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
4906 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
4907 
4908 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
4909 
4910 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
4911 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4912 
4913 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
4914 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
4915 
4916 	const void *privid;
4917 
4918 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
4919 
4920 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4921 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
4922 
4923 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
4924 
4925 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
4926 
4927 	struct device dev;
4928 
4929 	bool registered;
4930 
4931 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
4932 
4933 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
4934 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
4935 
4936 	struct list_head wdev_list;
4937 
4938 	possible_net_t _net;
4939 
4940 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
4941 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
4942 #endif
4943 
4944 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
4945 
4946 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
4947 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
4948 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
4949 
4950 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
4951 
4952 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
4953 
4954 	u32 bss_select_support;
4955 
4956 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
4957 
4958 	u32 txq_limit;
4959 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
4960 	u32 txq_quantum;
4961 
4962 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
4963 
4964 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
4965 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
4966 
4967 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
4968 
4969 	struct {
4970 		u64 peer, vif;
4971 		u8 max_retry;
4972 	} tid_config_support;
4973 
4974 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
4975 
4976 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
4977 };
4978 
4979 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
4980 {
4981 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
4982 }
4983 
4984 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
4985 {
4986 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
4987 }
4988 
4989 /**
4990  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
4991  *
4992  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
4993  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
4994  */
4995 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
4996 {
4997 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
4998 	return &wiphy->priv;
4999 }
5000 
5001 /**
5002  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5003  *
5004  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5005  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5006  */
5007 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5008 {
5009 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5010 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5011 }
5012 
5013 /**
5014  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5015  *
5016  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5017  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5018  */
5019 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5020 {
5021 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5022 }
5023 
5024 /**
5025  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5026  *
5027  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5028  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5029  */
5030 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5031 {
5032 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5033 }
5034 
5035 /**
5036  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5037  *
5038  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5039  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5040  */
5041 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5042 {
5043 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5044 }
5045 
5046 /**
5047  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5048  *
5049  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5050  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5051  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5052  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5053  *
5054  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5055  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5056  *
5057  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5058  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5059  */
5060 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5061 			   const char *requested_name);
5062 
5063 /**
5064  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5065  *
5066  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5067  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5068  *
5069  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5070  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5071  *
5072  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5073  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5074  */
5075 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5076 				      int sizeof_priv)
5077 {
5078 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5079 }
5080 
5081 /**
5082  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5083  *
5084  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5085  *
5086  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5087  */
5088 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5089 
5090 /**
5091  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5092  *
5093  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5094  *
5095  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5096  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5097  * request that is being handled.
5098  */
5099 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5100 
5101 /**
5102  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5103  *
5104  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5105  */
5106 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5107 
5108 /* internal structs */
5109 struct cfg80211_conn;
5110 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5111 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5112 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5113 
5114 /**
5115  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5116  *
5117  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5118  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5119  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5120  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5121  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device.
5122  *
5123  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5124  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5125  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5126  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5127  *
5128  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5129  * @iftype: interface type
5130  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5131  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5132  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5133  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5134  * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5135  * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
5136  *	the user-set channel definition.
5137  * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
5138  *	track the channel to be used for AP later
5139  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5140  * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5141  * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5142  * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5143  * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5144  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5145  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5146  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5147  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5148  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5149  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5150  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5151  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5152  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5153  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5154  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5155  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5156  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5157  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5158  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5159  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5160  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5161  * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list
5162  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5163  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5164  * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5165  *	and some API functions require it held
5166  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5167  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5168  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5169  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5170  *	the P2P Device.
5171  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5172  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5173  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5174  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5175  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5176  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5177  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5178  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5179  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5180  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5181  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5182  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5183  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5184  * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
5185  * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
5186  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5187  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5188  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5189  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5190  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5191  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5192  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5193  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5194  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5195  *	unprotected beacon report
5196  */
5197 struct wireless_dev {
5198 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5199 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5200 
5201 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5202 	struct list_head list;
5203 	struct net_device *netdev;
5204 
5205 	u32 identifier;
5206 
5207 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5208 	spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock;
5209 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5210 
5211 	struct mutex mtx;
5212 
5213 	bool use_4addr, is_running;
5214 
5215 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5216 
5217 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5218 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5219 	u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
5220 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5221 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5222 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5223 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5224 
5225 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5226 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5227 
5228 	struct list_head event_list;
5229 	spinlock_t event_lock;
5230 
5231 	struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
5232 	struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
5233 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
5234 
5235 	bool ibss_fixed;
5236 	bool ibss_dfs_possible;
5237 
5238 	bool ps;
5239 	int ps_timeout;
5240 
5241 	int beacon_interval;
5242 
5243 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5244 
5245 	u32 owner_nlportid;
5246 	bool nl_owner_dead;
5247 
5248 	bool cac_started;
5249 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5250 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5251 
5252 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5253 	/* wext data */
5254 	struct {
5255 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5256 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5257 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5258 		const u8 *ie;
5259 		size_t ie_len;
5260 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5261 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5262 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5263 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5264 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5265 	} wext;
5266 #endif
5267 
5268 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
5269 
5270 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
5271 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
5272 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
5273 
5274 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
5275 };
5276 
5277 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5278 {
5279 	if (wdev->netdev)
5280 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
5281 	return wdev->address;
5282 }
5283 
5284 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5285 {
5286 	if (wdev->netdev)
5287 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
5288 	return wdev->is_running;
5289 }
5290 
5291 /**
5292  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
5293  *
5294  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
5295  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
5296  */
5297 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5298 {
5299 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
5300 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5301 }
5302 
5303 /**
5304  * DOC: Utility functions
5305  *
5306  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5307  */
5308 
5309 /**
5310  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
5311  *
5312  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
5313  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
5314  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
5315  */
5316 static inline bool
5317 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
5318 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
5319 {
5320 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
5321 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
5322 }
5323 
5324 /**
5325  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
5326  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
5327  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
5328  */
5329 static inline u32
5330 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5331 {
5332 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
5333 }
5334 
5335 /**
5336  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
5337  *
5338  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
5339  * @chan: channel
5340  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
5341  */
5342 enum nl80211_chan_width
5343 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
5344 
5345 /**
5346  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
5347  * @chan: channel number
5348  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5349  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5350  */
5351 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5352 
5353 /**
5354  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5355  * @chan: channel number
5356  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5357  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5358  */
5359 static inline int
5360 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
5361 {
5362 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
5363 }
5364 
5365 /**
5366  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5367  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
5368  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5369  */
5370 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
5371 
5372 /**
5373  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5374  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
5375  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5376  */
5377 static inline int
5378 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
5379 {
5380 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5381 }
5382 
5383 /**
5384  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
5385  * frequency
5386  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5387  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
5388  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5389  */
5390 struct ieee80211_channel *
5391 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
5392 
5393 /**
5394  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5395  *
5396  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5397  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
5398  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5399  */
5400 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
5401 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
5402 {
5403 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5404 }
5405 
5406 /**
5407  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
5408  * @chan: control channel to check
5409  *
5410  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
5411  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
5412  */
5413 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5414 {
5415 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
5416 		return false;
5417 
5418 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
5419 }
5420 
5421 /**
5422  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5423  *
5424  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5425  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5426  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5427  *
5428  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5429  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5430  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5431  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5432  */
5433 struct ieee80211_rate *
5434 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5435 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5436 
5437 /**
5438  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5439  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5440  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5441  *
5442  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5443  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5444  */
5445 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5446 			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5447 
5448 /*
5449  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5450  *
5451  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5452  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
5453  */
5454 
5455 struct radiotap_align_size {
5456 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5457 };
5458 
5459 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5460 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5461 	int n_bits;
5462 	uint32_t oui;
5463 	uint8_t subns;
5464 };
5465 
5466 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5467 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5468 	int n_ns;
5469 };
5470 
5471 /**
5472  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5473  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5474  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5475  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5476  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5477  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5478  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
5479  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5480  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5481  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5482  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5483  *	radiotap namespace or not
5484  *
5485  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5486  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5487  * @_arg_index: next argument index
5488  * @_arg: next argument pointer
5489  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5490  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5491  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5492  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5493  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5494  *	next bitmap word
5495  *
5496  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5497  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5498  */
5499 
5500 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5501 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5502 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5503 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5504 
5505 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5506 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
5507 
5508 	unsigned char *this_arg;
5509 	int this_arg_index;
5510 	int this_arg_size;
5511 
5512 	int is_radiotap_ns;
5513 
5514 	int _max_length;
5515 	int _arg_index;
5516 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5517 	int _reset_on_ext;
5518 };
5519 
5520 int
5521 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5522 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5523 				 int max_length,
5524 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5525 
5526 int
5527 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5528 
5529 
5530 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5531 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5532 
5533 /**
5534  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5535  *
5536  * @skb: the frame
5537  *
5538  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5539  * returns the 802.11 header length.
5540  *
5541  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5542  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5543  * 802.11 header.
5544  */
5545 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5546 
5547 /**
5548  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5549  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5550  * Return: The header length in bytes.
5551  */
5552 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5553 
5554 /**
5555  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5556  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5557  *	(first byte) will be accessed
5558  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5559  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5560  */
5561 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5562 
5563 /**
5564  * DOC: Data path helpers
5565  *
5566  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5567  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5568  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5569  */
5570 
5571 /**
5572  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5573  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5574  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5575  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
5576  * @addr: the device MAC address
5577  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5578  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
5579  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5580  */
5581 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5582 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5583 				  u8 data_offset);
5584 
5585 /**
5586  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5587  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5588  * @addr: the device MAC address
5589  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5590  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5591  */
5592 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5593 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5594 {
5595 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0);
5596 }
5597 
5598 /**
5599  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5600  *
5601  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5602  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5603  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5604  *
5605  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5606  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5607  *	initialized by the caller.
5608  * @addr: The device MAC address.
5609  * @iftype: The device interface type.
5610  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5611  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5612  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5613  */
5614 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5615 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5616 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5617 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
5618 
5619 /**
5620  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5621  * @skb: the data frame
5622  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5623  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5624  */
5625 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5626 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5627 
5628 /**
5629  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5630  *
5631  * @eid: element ID
5632  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5633  * @len: length of data
5634  * @match: byte array to match
5635  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5636  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5637  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5638  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5639  *	the data portion instead.
5640  *
5641  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5642  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5643  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5644  * requested element struct.
5645  *
5646  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5647  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5648  * byte array to match.
5649  */
5650 const struct element *
5651 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5652 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5653 			 unsigned int match_offset);
5654 
5655 /**
5656  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5657  *
5658  * @eid: element ID
5659  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5660  * @len: length of data
5661  * @match: byte array to match
5662  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5663  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5664  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5665  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5666  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5667  *	the second byte is the IE length.
5668  *
5669  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5670  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5671  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5672  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5673  * element ID.
5674  *
5675  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5676  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5677  * byte array to match.
5678  */
5679 static inline const u8 *
5680 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5681 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5682 		       unsigned int match_offset)
5683 {
5684 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5685 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5686 	 */
5687 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5688 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
5689 		return NULL;
5690 
5691 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5692 						match, match_len,
5693 						match_offset ?
5694 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
5695 }
5696 
5697 /**
5698  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5699  *
5700  * @eid: element ID
5701  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5702  * @len: length of data
5703  *
5704  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5705  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5706  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5707  * requested element struct.
5708  *
5709  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5710  * having to fit into the given data.
5711  */
5712 static inline const struct element *
5713 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5714 {
5715 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5716 }
5717 
5718 /**
5719  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5720  *
5721  * @eid: element ID
5722  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5723  * @len: length of data
5724  *
5725  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5726  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5727  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5728  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5729  *
5730  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5731  * having to fit into the given data.
5732  */
5733 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5734 {
5735 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5736 }
5737 
5738 /**
5739  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5740  *
5741  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5742  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5743  * @len: length of data
5744  *
5745  * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5746  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5747  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5748  * requested element struct.
5749  *
5750  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5751  * having to fit into the given data.
5752  */
5753 static inline const struct element *
5754 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5755 {
5756 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5757 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
5758 }
5759 
5760 /**
5761  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5762  *
5763  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5764  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5765  * @len: length of data
5766  *
5767  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5768  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5769  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5770  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5771  *
5772  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5773  * having to fit into the given data.
5774  */
5775 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5776 {
5777 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5778 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5779 }
5780 
5781 /**
5782  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
5783  *
5784  * @oui: vendor OUI
5785  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5786  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5787  * @len: length of data
5788  *
5789  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5790  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
5791  * return the element structure for the requested element.
5792  *
5793  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5794  * the given data.
5795  */
5796 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5797 						const u8 *ies,
5798 						unsigned int len);
5799 
5800 /**
5801  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
5802  *
5803  * @oui: vendor OUI
5804  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5805  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5806  * @len: length of data
5807  *
5808  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5809  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
5810  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5811  * element ID.
5812  *
5813  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5814  * the given data.
5815  */
5816 static inline const u8 *
5817 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5818 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
5819 {
5820 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
5821 }
5822 
5823 /**
5824  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
5825  *
5826  * @dev: network device
5827  * @addr: STA MAC address
5828  *
5829  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
5830  * devices upon STA association.
5831  */
5832 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
5833 
5834 /**
5835  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
5836  *
5837  * TODO
5838  */
5839 
5840 /**
5841  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
5842  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
5843  *	conflicts)
5844  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
5845  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
5846  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
5847  *	alpha2.
5848  *
5849  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
5850  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
5851  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
5852  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
5853  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
5854  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
5855  *
5856  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
5857  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
5858  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
5859  *
5860  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
5861  * an -ENOMEM.
5862  *
5863  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
5864  */
5865 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
5866 
5867 /**
5868  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
5869  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5870  * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
5871  *
5872  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
5873  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
5874  * information.
5875  *
5876  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5877  */
5878 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5879 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5880 
5881 /**
5882  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers
5883  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5884  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
5885  *
5886  * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain
5887  * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see
5888  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
5889  *
5890  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5891  */
5892 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5893 					struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5894 
5895 /**
5896  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
5897  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5898  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
5899  *
5900  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
5901  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
5902  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
5903  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
5904  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
5905  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
5906  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
5907  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
5908  * that called this helper.
5909  */
5910 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5911 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
5912 
5913 /**
5914  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
5915  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
5916  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
5917  *
5918  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
5919  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
5920  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
5921  * and processed already.
5922  *
5923  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
5924  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
5925  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
5926  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
5927  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
5928  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
5929  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
5930  */
5931 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5932 					       u32 center_freq);
5933 
5934 /**
5935  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
5936  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
5937  *
5938  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
5939  * proper string representation.
5940  */
5941 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
5942 
5943 /**
5944  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
5945  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
5946  *
5947  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
5948  */
5949 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5950 
5951 /**
5952  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
5953  *
5954  */
5955 
5956 /**
5957  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
5958  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
5959  *
5960  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
5961  * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
5962  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
5963  *
5964  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
5965  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
5966  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
5967  *
5968  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
5969  * an -ENODATA.
5970  *
5971  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
5972  */
5973 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
5974 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
5975 
5976 /*
5977  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
5978  * functions and BSS handling helpers
5979  */
5980 
5981 /**
5982  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
5983  *
5984  * @request: the corresponding scan request
5985  * @info: information about the completed scan
5986  */
5987 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
5988 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5989 
5990 /**
5991  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
5992  *
5993  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
5994  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
5995  */
5996 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
5997 
5998 /**
5999  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6000  *
6001  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6002  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6003  *
6004  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6005  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6006  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6007  */
6008 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6009 
6010 /**
6011  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6012  *
6013  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6014  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6015  *
6016  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6017  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6018  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6019  * This function should be called with rtnl locked.
6020  */
6021 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6022 
6023 /**
6024  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6025  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6026  * @data: the BSS metadata
6027  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6028  * @len: length of the management frame
6029  * @gfp: context flags
6030  *
6031  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6032  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6033  *
6034  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6035  * Or %NULL on error.
6036  */
6037 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6038 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6039 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6040 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6041 			       gfp_t gfp);
6042 
6043 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6044 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6045 				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6046 				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6047 				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6048 				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6049 {
6050 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6051 		.chan = rx_channel,
6052 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6053 		.signal = signal,
6054 	};
6055 
6056 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6057 }
6058 
6059 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6060 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6061 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6062 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6063 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6064 {
6065 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6066 		.chan = rx_channel,
6067 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6068 		.signal = signal,
6069 	};
6070 
6071 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6072 }
6073 
6074 /**
6075  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6076  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6077  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6078  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6079  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6080  */
6081 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6082 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6083 {
6084 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6085 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6086 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6087 
6088 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6089 
6090 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6091 
6092 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6093 }
6094 
6095 /**
6096  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6097  * @element: element to check
6098  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6099  */
6100 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6101 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6102 
6103 /**
6104  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6105  * @ie: ies
6106  * @ielen: length of IEs
6107  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6108  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6109  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6110  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6111  */
6112 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6113 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6114 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6115 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6116 
6117 /**
6118  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6119  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6120  *	from a beacon or probe response
6121  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6122  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6123  */
6124 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6125 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6126 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6127 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6128 };
6129 
6130 /**
6131  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6132  *
6133  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6134  * @data: the BSS metadata
6135  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6136  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6137  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6138  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6139  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6140  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6141  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6142  * @gfp: context flags
6143  *
6144  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6145  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6146  *
6147  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6148  * Or %NULL on error.
6149  */
6150 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6151 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6152 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6153 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6154 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6155 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6156 			 gfp_t gfp);
6157 
6158 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6159 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6160 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6161 			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6162 			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6163 			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6164 			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6165 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6166 {
6167 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6168 		.chan = rx_channel,
6169 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6170 		.signal = signal,
6171 	};
6172 
6173 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6174 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6175 					gfp);
6176 }
6177 
6178 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6179 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6180 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6181 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6182 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6183 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6184 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6185 {
6186 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6187 		.chan = rx_channel,
6188 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6189 		.signal = signal,
6190 	};
6191 
6192 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6193 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6194 					gfp);
6195 }
6196 
6197 /**
6198  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
6199  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6200  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
6201  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
6202  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
6203  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
6204  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
6205  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
6206  */
6207 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6208 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6209 				      const u8 *bssid,
6210 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
6211 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
6212 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
6213 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
6214 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6215 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6216 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
6217 {
6218 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
6219 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
6220 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
6221 }
6222 
6223 /**
6224  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
6225  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6226  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
6227  *
6228  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6229  */
6230 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6231 
6232 /**
6233  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
6234  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6235  * @bss: the BSS struct
6236  *
6237  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6238  */
6239 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6240 
6241 /**
6242  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
6243  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6244  * @bss: the bss to remove
6245  *
6246  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
6247  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
6248  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
6249  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
6250  */
6251 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6252 
6253 /**
6254  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
6255  *
6256  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
6257  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
6258  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
6259  *
6260  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6261  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
6262  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
6263  * @iter: the iterator function to call
6264  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
6265  */
6266 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6267 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6268 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6269 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6270 				    void *data),
6271 		       void *iter_data);
6272 
6273 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
6274 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
6275 {
6276 	switch (chandef->width) {
6277 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
6278 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
6279 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
6280 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
6281 	default:
6282 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6283 	}
6284 }
6285 
6286 /**
6287  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
6288  * @dev: network device
6289  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
6290  * @len: length of the frame data
6291  *
6292  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
6293  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
6294  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
6295  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6296  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6297  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6298  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
6299  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
6300  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
6301  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
6302  *
6303  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6304  */
6305 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6306 
6307 /**
6308  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
6309  * @dev: network device
6310  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
6311  *
6312  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
6313  * mutex.
6314  */
6315 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6316 
6317 /**
6318  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
6319  * @dev: network device
6320  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
6321  *	moves to cfg80211 in this call
6322  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
6323  * @len: length of the frame data
6324  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
6325  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
6326  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
6327  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
6328  *
6329  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6330  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6331  *
6332  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6333  */
6334 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
6335 			    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6336 			    const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6337 			    int uapsd_queues,
6338 			    const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
6339 
6340 /**
6341  * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
6342  * @dev: network device
6343  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
6344  *
6345  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6346  */
6347 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6348 
6349 /**
6350  * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
6351  * @dev: network device
6352  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
6353  *
6354  * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
6355  * an association attempt was abandoned.
6356  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6357  */
6358 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6359 
6360 /**
6361  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
6362  * @dev: network device
6363  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
6364  * @len: length of the frame data
6365  *
6366  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
6367  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
6368  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
6369  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
6370  */
6371 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6372 
6373 /**
6374  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
6375  * @dev: network device
6376  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
6377  * @len: length of the frame data
6378  *
6379  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
6380  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
6381  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
6382  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
6383  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
6384  *
6385  * This function may sleep.
6386  */
6387 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
6388 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6389 
6390 /**
6391  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6392  * @dev: network device
6393  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6394  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6395  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6396  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6397  * @gfp: allocation flags
6398  *
6399  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6400  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6401  * primitive.
6402  */
6403 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6404 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6405 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6406 
6407 /**
6408  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6409  *
6410  * @dev: network device
6411  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6412  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6413  * @gfp: allocation flags
6414  *
6415  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6416  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6417  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6418  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6419  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6420  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6421  */
6422 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6423 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6424 
6425 /**
6426  * cfg80211_notify_new_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer candidate
6427  *
6428  * @dev: network device
6429  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6430  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6431  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
6432  * @gfp: allocation flags
6433  *
6434  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6435  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6436  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6437  */
6438 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6439 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6440 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6441 
6442 /**
6443  * DOC: RFkill integration
6444  *
6445  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6446  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6447  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6448  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6449  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6450  *
6451  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6452  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6453  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6454  */
6455 
6456 /**
6457  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6458  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6459  * @blocked: block status
6460  */
6461 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked);
6462 
6463 /**
6464  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6465  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6466  */
6467 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6468 
6469 /**
6470  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6471  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6472  */
6473 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6474 
6475 /**
6476  * DOC: Vendor commands
6477  *
6478  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6479  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6480  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6481  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6482  * the configuration mechanism.
6483  *
6484  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6485  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6486  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6487  *
6488  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6489  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6490  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6491  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6492  * managers etc. need.
6493  */
6494 
6495 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6496 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6497 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6498 					   int approxlen);
6499 
6500 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6501 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6502 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6503 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6504 					   unsigned int portid,
6505 					   int vendor_event_idx,
6506 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6507 
6508 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6509 
6510 /**
6511  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6512  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6513  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6514  *	be put into the skb
6515  *
6516  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6517  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6518  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6519  *
6520  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6521  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6522  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6523  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6524  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6525  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6526  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6527  *
6528  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6529  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6530  *
6531  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6532  */
6533 static inline struct sk_buff *
6534 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6535 {
6536 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6537 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6538 }
6539 
6540 /**
6541  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6542  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6543  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6544  *
6545  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6546  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6547  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
6548  * skb regardless of the return value.
6549  *
6550  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6551  */
6552 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6553 
6554 /**
6555  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender
6556  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6557  *
6558  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6559  * Valid to call only there.
6560  */
6561 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6562 
6563 /**
6564  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6565  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6566  * @wdev: the wireless device
6567  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6568  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6569  *	be put into the skb
6570  * @gfp: allocation flags
6571  *
6572  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6573  * vendor-specific multicast group.
6574  *
6575  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6576  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6577  * attribute.
6578  *
6579  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6580  * skb to send the event.
6581  *
6582  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6583  */
6584 static inline struct sk_buff *
6585 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6586 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6587 {
6588 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6589 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6590 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6591 }
6592 
6593 /**
6594  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6595  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6596  * @wdev: the wireless device
6597  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6598  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6599  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6600  *	be put into the skb
6601  * @gfp: allocation flags
6602  *
6603  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6604  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6605  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6606  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6607  *
6608  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6609  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6610  * attribute.
6611  *
6612  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6613  * skb to send the event.
6614  *
6615  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6616  */
6617 static inline struct sk_buff *
6618 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6619 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6620 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6621 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6622 {
6623 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6624 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6625 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6626 }
6627 
6628 /**
6629  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6630  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6631  * @gfp: allocation flags
6632  *
6633  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6634  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6635  */
6636 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6637 {
6638 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6639 }
6640 
6641 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6642 /**
6643  * DOC: Test mode
6644  *
6645  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6646  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6647  * factory programming.
6648  *
6649  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6650  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6651  */
6652 
6653 /**
6654  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6655  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6656  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6657  *	be put into the skb
6658  *
6659  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6660  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6661  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6662  *
6663  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6664  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6665  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6666  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6667  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6668  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6669  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6670  *
6671  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6672  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6673  *
6674  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6675  */
6676 static inline struct sk_buff *
6677 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6678 {
6679 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6680 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6681 }
6682 
6683 /**
6684  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6685  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6686  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6687  *
6688  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6689  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6690  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
6691  * regardless of the return value.
6692  *
6693  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6694  */
6695 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6696 {
6697 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6698 }
6699 
6700 /**
6701  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6702  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6703  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6704  *	be put into the skb
6705  * @gfp: allocation flags
6706  *
6707  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6708  * testmode multicast group.
6709  *
6710  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6711  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6712  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6713  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6714  * in any other way.
6715  *
6716  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6717  * skb to send the event.
6718  *
6719  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6720  */
6721 static inline struct sk_buff *
6722 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6723 {
6724 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6725 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6726 					  approxlen, gfp);
6727 }
6728 
6729 /**
6730  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6731  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6732  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6733  * @gfp: allocation flags
6734  *
6735  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6736  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6737  * consumes it.
6738  */
6739 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6740 {
6741 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6742 }
6743 
6744 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6745 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
6746 #else
6747 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6748 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6749 #endif
6750 
6751 /**
6752  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6753  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6754  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6755  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6756  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6757  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6758  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6759  *	status for a FILS connection.
6760  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6761  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6762  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6763  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6764  */
6765 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6766 	const u8 *kek;
6767 	size_t kek_len;
6768 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
6769 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
6770 	const u8 *pmk;
6771 	size_t pmk_len;
6772 	const u8 *pmkid;
6773 };
6774 
6775 /**
6776  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
6777  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6778  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6779  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6780  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6781  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6782  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6783  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6784  *	case.
6785  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
6786  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6787  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6788  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6789  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6790  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6791  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6792  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
6793  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
6794  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6795  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
6796  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
6797  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6798  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6799  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6800  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6801  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6802  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6803  */
6804 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
6805 	int status;
6806 	const u8 *bssid;
6807 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
6808 	const u8 *req_ie;
6809 	size_t req_ie_len;
6810 	const u8 *resp_ie;
6811 	size_t resp_ie_len;
6812 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
6813 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
6814 };
6815 
6816 /**
6817  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6818  *
6819  * @dev: network device
6820  * @params: connection response parameters
6821  * @gfp: allocation flags
6822  *
6823  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6824  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6825  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
6826  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
6827  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
6828  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6829  */
6830 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
6831 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
6832 			   gfp_t gfp);
6833 
6834 /**
6835  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6836  *
6837  * @dev: network device
6838  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6839  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6840  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6841  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6842  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6843  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6844  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6845  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6846  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6847  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6848  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6849  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6850  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6851  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6852  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6853  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6854  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6855  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6856  *	case.
6857  * @gfp: allocation flags
6858  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6859  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6860  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6861  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6862  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6863  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6864  *
6865  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6866  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6867  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
6868  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
6869  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6870  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6871  */
6872 static inline void
6873 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6874 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
6875 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
6876 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
6877 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6878 {
6879 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
6880 
6881 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
6882 	params.status = status;
6883 	params.bssid = bssid;
6884 	params.bss = bss;
6885 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
6886 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
6887 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
6888 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
6889 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
6890 
6891 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
6892 }
6893 
6894 /**
6895  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6896  *
6897  * @dev: network device
6898  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6899  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6900  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6901  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6902  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6903  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6904  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6905  *	the real status code for failures.
6906  * @gfp: allocation flags
6907  *
6908  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6909  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6910  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
6911  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6912  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6913  */
6914 static inline void
6915 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6916 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
6917 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
6918 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
6919 {
6920 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
6921 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
6922 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
6923 }
6924 
6925 /**
6926  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
6927  *
6928  * @dev: network device
6929  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6930  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6931  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6932  * @gfp: allocation flags
6933  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
6934  *
6935  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
6936  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
6937  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
6938  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
6939  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
6940  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6941  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6942  */
6943 static inline void
6944 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6945 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
6946 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6947 {
6948 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
6949 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
6950 }
6951 
6952 /**
6953  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
6954  *
6955  * @channel: the channel of the new AP
6956  * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
6957  * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
6958  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6959  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6960  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6961  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6962  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
6963  */
6964 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
6965 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
6966 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
6967 	const u8 *bssid;
6968 	const u8 *req_ie;
6969 	size_t req_ie_len;
6970 	const u8 *resp_ie;
6971 	size_t resp_ie_len;
6972 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
6973 };
6974 
6975 /**
6976  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
6977  *
6978  * @dev: network device
6979  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
6980  * @gfp: allocation flags
6981  *
6982  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
6983  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
6984  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
6985  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
6986  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
6987  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
6988  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
6989  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
6990  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
6991  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
6992  */
6993 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
6994 		     gfp_t gfp);
6995 
6996 /**
6997  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
6998  *
6999  * @dev: network device
7000  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7001  * @gfp: allocation flags
7002  *
7003  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7004  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7005  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7006  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7007  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7008  * indicate the 802.11 association.
7009  */
7010 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7011 			      gfp_t gfp);
7012 
7013 /**
7014  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7015  *
7016  * @dev: network device
7017  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7018  * @ie_len: length of IEs
7019  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7020  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7021  * @gfp: allocation flags
7022  *
7023  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7024  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7025  */
7026 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7027 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7028 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7029 
7030 /**
7031  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7032  * @wdev: wireless device
7033  * @cookie: the request cookie
7034  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7035  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7036  *	channel
7037  * @gfp: allocation flags
7038  */
7039 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7040 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7041 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7042 
7043 /**
7044  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7045  * @wdev: wireless device
7046  * @cookie: the request cookie
7047  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7048  * @gfp: allocation flags
7049  */
7050 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7051 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7052 					gfp_t gfp);
7053 
7054 /**
7055  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7056  * @wdev: wireless device
7057  * @cookie: the requested cookie
7058  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7059  * @gfp: allocation flags
7060  */
7061 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7062 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7063 
7064 /**
7065  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7066  *
7067  * @sinfo: the station information
7068  * @gfp: allocation flags
7069  */
7070 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7071 
7072 /**
7073  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7074  * @sinfo: the station information
7075  *
7076  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7077  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7078  * the stack.)
7079  */
7080 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7081 {
7082 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7083 }
7084 
7085 /**
7086  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7087  *
7088  * @dev: the netdev
7089  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7090  * @sinfo: the station information
7091  * @gfp: allocation flags
7092  */
7093 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7094 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7095 
7096 /**
7097  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7098  * @dev: the netdev
7099  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7100  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
7101  * @gfp: allocation flags
7102  */
7103 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7104 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7105 
7106 /**
7107  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7108  *
7109  * @dev: the netdev
7110  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7111  * @gfp: allocation flags
7112  */
7113 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
7114 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
7115 {
7116 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
7117 }
7118 
7119 /**
7120  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
7121  *
7122  * @dev: the netdev
7123  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7124  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
7125  * @gfp: allocation flags
7126  *
7127  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
7128  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
7129  * for some reasons, this function is called.
7130  *
7131  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
7132  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
7133  */
7134 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7135 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
7136 			  gfp_t gfp);
7137 
7138 /**
7139  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7140  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7141  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
7142  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7143  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7144  * @len: length of the frame data
7145  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7146  *
7147  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7148  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7149  *
7150  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7151  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7152  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7153  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7154  */
7155 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
7156 			  const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
7157 
7158 /**
7159  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7160  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7161  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
7162  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7163  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7164  * @len: length of the frame data
7165  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7166  *
7167  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7168  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7169  *
7170  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7171  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7172  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7173  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7174  */
7175 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
7176 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7177 				    u32 flags)
7178 {
7179 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len,
7180 				    flags);
7181 }
7182 
7183 /**
7184  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
7185  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7186  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
7187  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7188  * @len: length of the frame data
7189  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7190  * @gfp: context flags
7191  *
7192  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
7193  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
7194  * transmission attempt.
7195  */
7196 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7197 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
7198 
7199 /**
7200  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
7201  *                                   port frames
7202  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7203  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
7204  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
7205  * @len: length of the frame data
7206  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7207  * @gfp: context flags
7208  *
7209  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
7210  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
7211  * the transmission attempt.
7212  */
7213 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7214 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
7215 				     gfp_t gfp);
7216 
7217 /**
7218  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
7219  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7220  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
7221  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
7222  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
7223  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
7224  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
7225  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
7226  *
7227  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
7228  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
7229  * control port frames over nl80211.
7230  *
7231  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
7232  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
7233  *
7234  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
7235  */
7236 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
7237 			      struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
7238 
7239 /**
7240  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
7241  * @dev: network device
7242  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
7243  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7244  * @gfp: context flags
7245  *
7246  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
7247  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
7248  */
7249 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7250 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7251 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
7252 
7253 /**
7254  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
7255  * @dev: network device
7256  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7257  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
7258  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
7259  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
7260  * @gfp: context flags
7261  */
7262 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7263 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
7264 
7265 /**
7266  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
7267  * @dev: network device
7268  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7269  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
7270  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
7271  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
7272  * @gfp: context flags
7273  *
7274  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
7275  * given interval is exceeded.
7276  */
7277 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7278 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
7279 
7280 /**
7281  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
7282  * @dev: network device
7283  * @gfp: context flags
7284  *
7285  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
7286  */
7287 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
7288 
7289 /**
7290  * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
7291  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7292  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7293  * @gfp: context flags
7294  *
7295  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
7296  */
7297 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7298 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
7299 
7300 /**
7301  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
7302  * @dev: network device
7303  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
7304  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
7305  * @gfp: context flags
7306  *
7307  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
7308  * frame.
7309  */
7310 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
7311 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
7312 				       gfp_t gfp);
7313 
7314 /**
7315  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
7316  * @netdev: network device
7317  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7318  * @event: type of event
7319  * @gfp: context flags
7320  *
7321  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
7322  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
7323  * also by full-MAC drivers.
7324  */
7325 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7326 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7327 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
7328 
7329 
7330 /**
7331  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
7332  * @dev: network device
7333  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
7334  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
7335  * @gfp: allocation flags
7336  */
7337 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7338 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
7339 
7340 /**
7341  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
7342  * @dev: network device
7343  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
7344  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
7345  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
7346  * @gfp: allocation flags
7347  */
7348 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
7349 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
7350 
7351 /**
7352  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
7353  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7354  * @addr: the transmitter address
7355  * @gfp: context flags
7356  *
7357  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7358  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
7359  * sender.
7360  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7361  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7362  */
7363 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7364 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7365 
7366 /**
7367  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
7368  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7369  * @addr: the transmitter address
7370  * @gfp: context flags
7371  *
7372  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7373  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
7374  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
7375  * station to avoid event flooding.
7376  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7377  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7378  */
7379 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7380 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7381 
7382 /**
7383  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
7384  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
7385  * @addr: the address of the peer
7386  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
7387  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
7388  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
7389  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
7390  * @gfp: allocation flags
7391  */
7392 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7393 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
7394 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
7395 
7396 /**
7397  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
7398  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7399  * @frame: the frame
7400  * @len: length of the frame
7401  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
7402  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7403  *
7404  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7405  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7406  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7407  */
7408 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
7409 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
7410 
7411 /**
7412  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
7413  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7414  * @frame: the frame
7415  * @len: length of the frame
7416  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
7417  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7418  *
7419  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7420  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7421  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7422  */
7423 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7424 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
7425 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
7426 {
7427 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
7428 					sig_dbm);
7429 }
7430 
7431 /**
7432  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
7433  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7434  * @chandef: the channel definition
7435  * @iftype: interface type
7436  *
7437  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7438  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
7439  */
7440 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7441 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7442 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7443 
7444 /**
7445  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
7446  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7447  * @chandef: the channel definition
7448  * @iftype: interface type
7449  *
7450  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7451  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7452  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7453  * more permissive conditions.
7454  *
7455  * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7456  */
7457 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7458 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7459 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7460 
7461 /*
7462  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7463  * @dev: the device which switched channels
7464  * @chandef: the new channel definition
7465  *
7466  * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7467  * driver context!
7468  */
7469 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7470 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
7471 
7472 /*
7473  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7474  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7475  * @chandef: the future channel definition
7476  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7477  *
7478  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7479  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7480  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7481  */
7482 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7483 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7484 				       u8 count);
7485 
7486 /**
7487  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7488  *
7489  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7490  * @band: band pointer to fill
7491  *
7492  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7493  */
7494 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7495 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
7496 
7497 /**
7498  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7499  *
7500  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7501  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7502  *
7503  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7504  */
7505 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7506 					  u8 *op_class);
7507 
7508 /**
7509  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
7510  *
7511  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7512  *
7513  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
7514  */
7515 static inline u32
7516 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7517 {
7518 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
7519 }
7520 
7521 /*
7522  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7523  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7524  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7525  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7526  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7527  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7528  * @gfp: allocation flags
7529  *
7530  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7531  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7532  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7533  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7534  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7535  */
7536 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7537 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7538 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7539 
7540 /*
7541  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7542  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7543  *
7544  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7545  */
7546 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7547 
7548 /**
7549  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7550  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7551  *
7552  * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned,
7553  * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that
7554  * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function
7555  * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by
7556  * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also
7557  * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g.
7558  * when the device is unbound from the driver.
7559  *
7560  * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7561  */
7562 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7563 
7564 /**
7565  * struct cfg80211_ft_event - FT Information Elements
7566  * @ies: FT IEs
7567  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7568  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7569  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7570  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7571  */
7572 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7573 	const u8 *ies;
7574 	size_t ies_len;
7575 	const u8 *target_ap;
7576 	const u8 *ric_ies;
7577 	size_t ric_ies_len;
7578 };
7579 
7580 /**
7581  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7582  * @netdev: network device
7583  * @ft_event: IE information
7584  */
7585 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7586 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7587 
7588 /**
7589  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7590  * @ies: the input IE buffer
7591  * @len: the input length
7592  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7593  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7594  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7595  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7596  *
7597  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7598  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7599  *
7600  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7601  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7602  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7603  */
7604 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7605 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7606 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7607 
7608 /**
7609  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7610  * @ies: the IE buffer
7611  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7612  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7613  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7614  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7615  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7616  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7617  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7618  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7619  *
7620  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7621  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7622  * split.
7623  *
7624  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7625  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7626  *
7627  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7628  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7629  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7630  *
7631  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7632  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7633  * of the buffer should be used.
7634  */
7635 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7636 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7637 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7638 			      size_t offset);
7639 
7640 /**
7641  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7642  * @ies: the IE buffer
7643  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7644  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7645  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7646  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7647  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7648  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7649  *
7650  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7651  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7652  * split.
7653  *
7654  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7655  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7656  *
7657  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7658  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7659  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7660  *
7661  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7662  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7663  * of the buffer should be used.
7664  */
7665 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7666 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7667 {
7668 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7669 }
7670 
7671 /**
7672  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7673  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7674  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7675  * @gfp: allocation flags
7676  *
7677  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7678  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7679  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7680  * else caused the wakeup.
7681  */
7682 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7683 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7684 				   gfp_t gfp);
7685 
7686 /**
7687  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7688  *
7689  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7690  * @gfp: allocation flags
7691  *
7692  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7693  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7694  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7695  */
7696 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7697 
7698 /**
7699  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7700  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7701  *
7702  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7703  */
7704 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7705 
7706 /**
7707  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7708  *
7709  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7710  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7711  *
7712  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7713  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7714  * the interface combinations.
7715  */
7716 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7717 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
7718 
7719 /**
7720  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7721  *
7722  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7723  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7724  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7725  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7726  *
7727  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7728  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7729  * purposes.
7730  */
7731 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7732 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
7733 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7734 					    void *data),
7735 			       void *data);
7736 
7737 /*
7738  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7739  *
7740  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7741  * @wdev: wireless device
7742  * @gfp: context flags
7743  *
7744  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
7745  * disconnected.
7746  *
7747  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
7748  */
7749 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7750 			 gfp_t gfp);
7751 
7752 /**
7753  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
7754  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
7755  *
7756  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
7757  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
7758  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
7759  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
7760  *
7761  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
7762  * the driver while the function is running.
7763  */
7764 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7765 
7766 /**
7767  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
7768  *
7769  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7770  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7771  *
7772  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7773  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7774  */
7775 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7776 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7777 {
7778 	u8 *ft_byte;
7779 
7780 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7781 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
7782 }
7783 
7784 /**
7785  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
7786  *
7787  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7788  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7789  *
7790  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7791  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7792  */
7793 static inline bool
7794 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7795 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7796 {
7797 	u8 ft_byte;
7798 
7799 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7800 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
7801 }
7802 
7803 /**
7804  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
7805  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
7806  *
7807  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
7808  */
7809 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
7810 
7811 /**
7812  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
7813  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
7814  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
7815  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
7816  *	 result.
7817  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
7818  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7819  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
7820  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
7821  * @info_len: the length of the &info
7822  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
7823  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
7824  */
7825 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
7826 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
7827 	u8 inst_id;
7828 	u8 peer_inst_id;
7829 	const u8 *addr;
7830 	u8 info_len;
7831 	const u8 *info;
7832 	u64 cookie;
7833 };
7834 
7835 /**
7836  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
7837  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7838  * @match: match notification parameters
7839  * @gfp: allocation flags
7840  *
7841  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
7842  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
7843  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
7844  */
7845 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7846 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
7847 
7848 /**
7849  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7850  *
7851  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7852  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7853  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7854  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
7855  * @gfp: allocation flags
7856  *
7857  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
7858  */
7859 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7860 				  u8 inst_id,
7861 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7862 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
7863 
7864 /* ethtool helper */
7865 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
7866 
7867 /**
7868  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
7869  * @netdev: network device
7870  * @params: External authentication parameters
7871  * @gfp: allocation flags
7872  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
7873  */
7874 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
7875 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
7876 				   gfp_t gfp);
7877 
7878 /**
7879  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
7880  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7881  * @req: the original measurement request
7882  * @result: the result data
7883  * @gfp: allocation flags
7884  */
7885 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7886 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7887 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
7888 			  gfp_t gfp);
7889 
7890 /**
7891  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
7892  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7893  * @req: the original measurement request
7894  * @gfp: allocation flags
7895  *
7896  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
7897  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
7898  */
7899 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7900 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7901 			    gfp_t gfp);
7902 
7903 /**
7904  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
7905  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7906  * @iftype: interface type
7907  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
7908  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
7909  *
7910  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
7911  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
7912  * check_swif is '1'.
7913  */
7914 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
7915 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
7916 
7917 
7918 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
7919 
7920 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
7921 
7922 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
7923 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7924 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7925 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7926 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7927 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7928 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7929 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7930 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7931 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7932 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7933 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7934 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7935 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7936 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7937 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7938 
7939 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
7940 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7941 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
7942 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7943 
7944 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7945 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
7946 
7947 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7948 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7949 
7950 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
7951 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
7952 #else
7953 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
7954 ({									\
7955 	if (0)								\
7956 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
7957 	0;								\
7958 })
7959 #endif
7960 
7961 /*
7962  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
7963  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
7964  * file/line information and a backtrace.
7965  */
7966 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7967 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
7968 
7969 /**
7970  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
7971  * @netdev: network device
7972  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
7973  * @gfp: allocation flags
7974  */
7975 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7976 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
7977 				    gfp_t gfp);
7978 
7979 /**
7980  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
7981  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7982  */
7983 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7984 
7985 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
7986